blob: bc9a57cd8ec0c2a06abfd2b57bf3d46053e72232 [file] [log] [blame]
Nick Lewycky5d9484d2013-01-24 01:12:16 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000014#include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000015#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +000016#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000018#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000019#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000020#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +000021#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000022#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +000023#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
David Majnemere9f6f332013-09-16 22:44:20 +000024#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000025#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
26#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor661b4932010-09-12 04:28:07 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Chandler Carruth55fc8732012-12-04 09:13:33 +000032#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregorbf3af052008-11-13 20:12:29 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +000034#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000035#include <algorithm>
36
37namespace clang {
John McCall2a7fb272010-08-25 05:32:35 +000038using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000039
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000040/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000041static ExprResult
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000042CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
43 bool HadMultipleCandidates,
Douglas Gregor5b8968c2011-07-15 16:25:15 +000044 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
45 const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000046 if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000047 return ExprError();
48 // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
49 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
50 // called on both.
51 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
52 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
53 // being used.
54 if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000055 return ExprError();
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000056 DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000057 VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
58 if (HadMultipleCandidates)
59 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000060
61 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000062
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000063 ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000064 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
65 if (E.isInvalid())
66 return ExprError();
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000067 return E;
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000068}
69
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000070static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
71 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +000072 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +000073 bool CStyle,
74 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
Sam Panzerd0125862012-08-16 02:38:47 +000075
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +000076static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
77 QualType &ToType,
78 bool InOverloadResolution,
79 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
80 bool CStyle);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000081static OverloadingResult
82IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
83 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
84 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +000085 bool AllowExplicit,
86 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000087
88
89static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
90CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
91 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
92 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
93
94static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
95CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
96 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
97 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
98
99static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
100CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
101 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
102 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
103
104
105
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000106/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
107/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000109GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
110 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
111 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
112 ICC_Identity,
113 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
114 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
115 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000116 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000117 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
118 ICC_Promotion,
119 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000120 ICC_Promotion,
121 ICC_Conversion,
122 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000123 ICC_Conversion,
124 ICC_Conversion,
125 ICC_Conversion,
126 ICC_Conversion,
127 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000128 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000129 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000130 ICC_Conversion,
131 ICC_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000132 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000133 ICC_Conversion
134 };
135 return Category[(int)Kind];
136}
137
138/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
139/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
140ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
141 static const ImplicitConversionRank
142 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
143 ICR_Exact_Match,
144 ICR_Exact_Match,
145 ICR_Exact_Match,
146 ICR_Exact_Match,
147 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000148 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000149 ICR_Promotion,
150 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000151 ICR_Promotion,
152 ICR_Conversion,
153 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000154 ICR_Conversion,
155 ICR_Conversion,
156 ICR_Conversion,
157 ICR_Conversion,
158 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000159 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000160 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000161 ICR_Conversion,
162 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000163 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
164 ICR_Conversion,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000165 ICR_Conversion,
166 ICR_Writeback_Conversion
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000167 };
168 return Rank[(int)Kind];
169}
170
171/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
172/// implicit conversion.
173const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopes2550d702009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000174 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000175 "No conversion",
176 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
177 "Array-to-pointer",
178 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000179 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000180 "Qualification",
181 "Integral promotion",
182 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000183 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000184 "Integral conversion",
185 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000186 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000187 "Floating-integral conversion",
188 "Pointer conversion",
189 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor15da57e2008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000190 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000191 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000192 "Derived-to-base conversion",
193 "Vector conversion",
194 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000195 "Complex-real conversion",
196 "Block Pointer conversion",
197 "Transparent Union Conversion"
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000198 "Writeback conversion"
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000199 };
200 return Name[Kind];
201}
202
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000203/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
204/// sequence to the identity conversion.
205void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
206 First = ICK_Identity;
207 Second = ICK_Identity;
208 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000209 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000210 QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000211 ReferenceBinding = false;
212 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000213 IsLvalueReference = true;
214 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
215 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000216 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +0000217 ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000218 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000219}
220
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
222/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
223/// implicit conversions.
224ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
225 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
226 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
227 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
228 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
229 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
230 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
231 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
232 return Rank;
233}
234
235/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
236/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000237/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000238/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000239bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000240 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
241 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
242 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
243 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000244 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCallddb0ce72010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000245 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
246 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
247 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlssonc8df0b62010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000248 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000249 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
250 return true;
251
252 return false;
253}
254
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000255/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
256/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
257/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
258/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000259bool
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000260StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000261isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000262 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000263 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000264
265 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
266 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
267 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
268 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
269 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
270
Douglas Gregorf9af5242011-04-15 20:45:44 +0000271 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000272 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000273 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
274
275 return false;
276}
277
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000278/// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
279/// or after one in an implicit conversion.
280static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
281 while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
282 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
283 case CK_NoOp:
284 case CK_IntegralCast:
285 case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
286 case CK_IntegralToFloating:
287 case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
288 case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
289 case CK_FloatingCast:
290 Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
291 continue;
292
293 default:
294 return Converted;
295 }
296 }
297
298 return Converted;
299}
300
301/// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
302/// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
303///
304/// \param Ctx The AST context.
305/// \param Converted The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
306/// \param ConstantValue If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
307/// value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000308/// \param ConstantType If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
309/// type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000310NarrowingKind
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +0000311StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
312 const Expr *Converted,
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000313 APValue &ConstantValue,
314 QualType &ConstantType) const {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000315 assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000316
317 // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
318 // A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
319 QualType FromType = getToType(0);
320 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
321 switch (Second) {
322 // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
323 //
324 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
325 // type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
326 // value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
327 // the original value when converted back to the original type, or
328 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
329 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
330 return NK_Type_Narrowing;
331 } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
332 llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
333 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
334 if (Initializer &&
335 Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
336 // Convert the integer to the floating type.
337 llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
338 Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
339 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
340 // And back.
341 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
342 bool ignored;
343 Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
344 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
345 // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
346 if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
347 ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000348 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000349 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
350 }
351 } else {
352 // Variables are always narrowings.
353 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
354 }
355 }
356 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
357
358 // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
359 // where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
360 // conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
361 // if it cannot be represented exactly), or
362 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
363 if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
364 Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
365 // FromType is larger than ToType.
366 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
367 if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
368 // Constant!
369 assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
370 llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
371 // Convert the source value into the target type.
372 bool ignored;
373 llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
374 Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
375 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
376 // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
377 // values that can be represented.
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000378 if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
379 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000380 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +0000381 }
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000382 } else {
383 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
384 }
385 }
386 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
387
388 // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
389 // that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
390 // the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
391 // conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
392 // value when converted back to the original type.
393 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion: // Bools are integers too.
394 if (!FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
395 // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
396 // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
397 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
398 } // Otherwise, fall through to the integral case.
399 case ICK_Integral_Conversion: {
400 assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
401 assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
402 const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
403 const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
404 const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
405 const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
406
407 if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000408 (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
409 (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000410 // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
411 llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
412 const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000413 if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
414 // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
415 return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000416 }
417 bool Narrowing = false;
418 if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000419 // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
420 // narrowing.
421 if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000422 Narrowing = true;
Richard Smithcd65f492012-06-13 01:07:41 +0000423 } else {
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000424 // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
425 // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
426 InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
427 InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
428 // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
429 llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
430 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
431 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
432 ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
433 ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
434 // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
Richard Smith5d7700e2012-06-19 21:28:35 +0000435 if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
436 Narrowing = true;
437 }
438 if (Narrowing) {
439 ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
440 ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
441 return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
Richard Smith4c3fc9b2012-01-18 05:21:49 +0000442 }
443 }
444 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
445 }
446
447 default:
448 // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
449 return NK_Not_Narrowing;
450 }
451}
452
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000453/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
454/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
455void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000456 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000457 bool PrintedSomething = false;
458 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000459 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000460 PrintedSomething = true;
461 }
462
463 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
464 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000465 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000466 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000467 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000468
469 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000470 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000471 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000472 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000473 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000474 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000475 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000476 PrintedSomething = true;
477 }
478
479 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
480 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000481 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000482 }
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000483 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000484 PrintedSomething = true;
485 }
486
487 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000488 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000489 }
490}
491
492/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
493/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
494void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000495 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000496 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
497 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000498 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000499 }
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +0000500 if (ConversionFunction)
501 OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
502 else
503 OS << "aggregate initialization";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000504 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000505 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000506 After.DebugPrint();
507 }
508}
509
510/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
511/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
512void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000513 raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Richard Smith798186a2013-09-06 22:30:28 +0000514 if (isStdInitializerListElement())
515 OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000516 switch (ConversionKind) {
517 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000518 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000519 Standard.DebugPrint();
520 break;
521 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000522 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000523 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
524 break;
525 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000526 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000527 break;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000528 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000529 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000530 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000531 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000532 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000533 break;
534 }
535
Daniel Dunbarf3f91f32010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000536 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000537}
538
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000539void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
540 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
541}
542
543void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
544 conversions().~ConversionSet();
545}
546
547void
548AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
549 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
550 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
551 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
552}
553
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000554namespace {
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000555 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000556 // template argument information.
557 struct DFIArguments {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000558 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
559 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
560 };
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000561 // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000562 // template parameter and template argument information.
563 struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
564 TemplateParameter Param;
565 };
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000566}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000567
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000568/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
569/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000570DeductionFailureInfo MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
571 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
572 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
573 DeductionFailureInfo Result;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000574 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000575 Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000576 Result.Data = 0;
577 switch (TDK) {
578 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000579 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000580 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000581 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
582 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000583 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000584
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000585 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000586 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000587 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
588 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000589
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000590 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
591 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
592 DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
593 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
594 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
595 Result.Data = Saved;
596 break;
597 }
598
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000599 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000600 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000601 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
602 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000603 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
604 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
605 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
606 Result.Data = Saved;
607 break;
608 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000609
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000610 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000611 Result.Data = Info.take();
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000612 if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
613 PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
614 SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
615 Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
616 Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
617 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000618 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000619
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000620 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000621 Result.Data = Info.Expression;
622 break;
623
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000624 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000625 break;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000626 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000627
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000628 return Result;
629}
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000630
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000631void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000632 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
633 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000634 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000635 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
636 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000637 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
638 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000639 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000640 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000641 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000642
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000643 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000644 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000645 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregoraaa045d2010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000646 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000647 Data = 0;
648 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000649
650 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000651 // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000652 Data = 0;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000653 if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
654 Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
655 HasDiagnostic = false;
656 }
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000657 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000658
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000659 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000660 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000661 break;
662 }
663}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000664
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000665PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +0000666 if (HasDiagnostic)
667 return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
668 return 0;
669}
670
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000671TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000672 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
673 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000674 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000675 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000676 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
677 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000678 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000679 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
680 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000681 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000682
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000683 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000684 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000685 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000686
687 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000688 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000689 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000690
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000691 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000692 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000693 break;
694 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000695
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000696 return TemplateParameter();
697}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000698
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000699TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000700 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000701 case Sema::TDK_Success:
702 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
703 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
704 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
705 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
706 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
707 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
708 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
711 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
712 return 0;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000713
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000714 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
715 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000717 // Unhandled
718 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
719 break;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000720 }
721
722 return 0;
723}
724
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000725const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000726 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
727 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000728 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000729 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
730 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000731 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
732 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000733 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000734 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000735 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000736 return 0;
737
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000738 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000739 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000740 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
741 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000742
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000743 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000744 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000745 break;
746 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000747
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000748 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000749}
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000750
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000751const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000752 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
753 case Sema::TDK_Success:
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +0000754 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000755 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
756 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000757 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
758 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000759 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000760 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000761 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000762 return 0;
763
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000764 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000765 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000766 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
767 return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000768
Douglas Gregor0ca4c582010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000769 // Unhandled
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +0000770 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000771 break;
772 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000773
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000774 return 0;
775}
776
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +0000777Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +0000778 if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
779 Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
780 return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
781
782 return 0;
783}
784
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000785void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000786 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
Benjamin Kramer9e2822b2012-01-14 20:16:52 +0000787 for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
788 i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
Richard Smithe3898ac2012-07-18 23:52:59 +0000789 if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
790 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
791 }
Benjamin Kramerf5b132f2012-10-09 15:52:25 +0000792}
793
794void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
795 destroyCandidates();
Benjamin Kramer314f5542012-01-14 19:31:39 +0000796 NumInlineSequences = 0;
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +0000797 Candidates.clear();
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000798 Functions.clear();
799}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000800
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000801namespace {
802 class UnbridgedCastsSet {
803 struct Entry {
804 Expr **Addr;
805 Expr *Saved;
806 };
807 SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
808
809 public:
810 void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
811 assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
812 Entry entry = { &E, E };
813 Entries.push_back(entry);
814 E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
815 }
816
817 void restore() {
818 for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
819 i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
820 *i->Addr = i->Saved;
821 }
822 };
823}
824
825/// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
826/// preprocessing on the given expression.
827///
828/// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
829/// without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
830///
831/// Return true on unrecoverable error.
832static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
833 UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000834 if (const BuiltinType *placeholder = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
835 // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
836 // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
837 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
838
839 // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
840 // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
841 if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
842 unbridgedCasts) {
843 unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
844 return false;
845 }
846
847 // Go ahead and check everything else.
848 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
849 if (result.isInvalid())
850 return true;
851
852 E = result.take();
853 return false;
854 }
855
856 // Nothing to do.
857 return false;
858}
859
860/// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
861/// placeholders.
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000862static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
863 MultiExprArg Args,
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000864 UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +0000865 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
866 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +0000867 return true;
868
869 return false;
870}
871
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000872// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000873// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
874// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
875// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
876// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000877// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
878// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
879// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000880//
881// Example: Given the following input:
882//
883// void f(int, float); // #1
884// void f(int, int); // #2
885// int f(int, int); // #3
886//
887// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000888// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000889//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000890// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
891// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
892// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
893// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000894//
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000895// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
896// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
897// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
898// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000899// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
900// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000901//
902// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
903// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
904// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
905// into a function template's signature.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000906Sema::OverloadKind
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000907Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
908 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000909 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000910 I != E; ++I) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000911 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
912
913 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
914 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
915 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
916
917 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
918 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
919 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
920
921 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
922 }
923
924 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
925 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
926 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
927 // function templates hide function templates with different
928 // return types or template parameter lists.
929 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
John McCall78037ac2013-04-03 21:19:47 +0000930 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
931 !New->getFriendObjectKind();
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000932
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000933 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000934 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
935 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
936 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
937 continue;
938 }
939
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000940 Match = *I;
941 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000942 }
John McCall51fa86f2009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000943 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000944 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
945 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
946 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
947 continue;
948 }
949
Rafael Espindola90cc3902013-04-15 12:49:13 +0000950 if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
951 continue;
952
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000953 Match = *I;
954 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000955 }
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000956 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000957 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
958 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
959 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalld7945c62010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000960 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
961 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall9f54ad42009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000962 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
963 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
964 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
965 // template instantiation.
966 } else {
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000967 // (C++ 13p1):
968 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
969 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000970 Match = *I;
971 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000972 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000973 }
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000974
John McCall871b2e72009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000975 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000976}
977
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000978bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
979 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
980 // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
981 if (New->isMain())
Rafael Espindola78eeba82012-12-28 14:21:58 +0000982 return false;
Rafael Espindola7a525ac2013-01-12 01:47:40 +0000983
David Majnemere9f6f332013-09-16 22:44:20 +0000984 // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
985 if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
986 return false;
987
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000988 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
989 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
990
991 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
992 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
993 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
994 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
995 return true;
996
997 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +0000998 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
999 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001000
1001 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1002 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1003 // in the signature, they are overloads.
1004
1005 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1006 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1007 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1008 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1009 return false;
1010
John McCallf4c73712011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001011 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1012 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001013
1014 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1015 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1016 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1017 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1018 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
1019 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001020 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001021 return true;
1022
1023 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1024 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
1025 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1026 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1027 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1028 // signature.
1029 //
1030 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1031 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00001032 //
1033 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1034 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1035 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001036 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1037 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1038 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001039 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
1040 return true;
1041
1042 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregor57c9f4f2011-01-26 17:47:49 +00001043 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001044 //
1045 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1046 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1047 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1048 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1049 // can be overloaded.
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001050 CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1051 CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001052 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001053 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1054 if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1055 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1056 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1057 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1058 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1059 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1060 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1061 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1062 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1063 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001064 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001065 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001066 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001067 }
1068 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001069 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001070
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001071 // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1072 // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1073 // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1074 // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
David Majnemer62e93702013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001075 unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001076 unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
Richard Smithaa4bc182013-06-30 09:48:50 +00001077 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
Richard Smithdb2fe732013-06-25 18:46:26 +00001078 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001079 NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
David Majnemer62e93702013-11-03 23:51:28 +00001080
1081 // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1082 OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1083 NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1084 if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
Richard Smith21c8fa82013-01-14 05:37:29 +00001085 return true;
Douglas Gregorb145ee62011-01-26 21:20:37 +00001086 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001087
John McCall68263142009-11-18 22:49:29 +00001088 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1089 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001090}
1091
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00001092/// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1093/// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1094///
1095/// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1096/// an available function, false otherwise.
1097bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1098 return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1099}
1100
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001101/// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1102///
1103/// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1104/// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1105static ImplicitConversionSequence
1106TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1107 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1108 bool AllowExplicit,
1109 bool InOverloadResolution,
1110 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001111 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1112 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001113 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1114
1115 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1116 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1117 // we can perform.
1118 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1119 return ICS;
1120 }
1121
1122 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1123 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
1124 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
1125 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001126 AllowExplicit, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001127
1128 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
1129 ICS.setUserDefined();
1130 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1131 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1132 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1133 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1134 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1135 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1136 // called for those cases.
1137 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1138 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1139 QualType FromCanon
1140 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1141 QualType ToCanon
1142 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1143 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1144 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1145 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1146 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1147 ICS.setStandard();
1148 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1149 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1150 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1151 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1152 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1153 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1154 }
1155 }
1156
1157 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
1158 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
1159 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
1160 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
1161 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
1162 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
1163 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
1164 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
1165 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
1166 }
1167 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
1168 ICS.setAmbiguous();
1169 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1170 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1171 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1172 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1173 if (Cand->Viable)
1174 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1175 } else {
1176 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1177 }
1178
1179 return ICS;
1180}
1181
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001182/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1183/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1184/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1185/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001186///
1187/// void f(float f);
1188/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
1189///
1190/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1191/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1192/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1193/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1194//
1195/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1196/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1197/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1198/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1199/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001200///
1201/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1202/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00001203/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1204/// permitted.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001205///
1206/// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1207/// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1208/// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209static ImplicitConversionSequence
1210TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1211 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001212 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001213 bool InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001214 bool CStyle,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001215 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1216 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001217 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001218 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001219 ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001220 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001221 return ICS;
1222 }
1223
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001224 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00001225 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00001226 return ICS;
1227 }
1228
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001229 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1230 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1231 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1232 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1233 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1234 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1235 // called for those cases.
1236 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1237 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001238 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1239 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001240 ICS.setStandard();
1241 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1242 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1243 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001244
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001245 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1246 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1247 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1248 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1249 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001250
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001251 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001252 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00001253 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001254
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00001255 return ICS;
1256 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001257
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00001258 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1259 AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001260 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1261 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001262}
1263
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001264ImplicitConversionSequence
1265Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1266 bool SuppressUserConversions,
1267 bool AllowExplicit,
1268 bool InOverloadResolution,
1269 bool CStyle,
1270 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1271 return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1272 SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1273 InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001274 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1275 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001276}
1277
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001278/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001279/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001280/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1281/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1282/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001283ExprResult
1284Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001285 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001286 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001287 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001288}
1289
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00001290ExprResult
1291Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001292 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
Sebastian Redl091fffe2011-10-16 18:19:06 +00001293 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00001294 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1295 return ExprError();
1296
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001297 // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1298 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001299 = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001300 (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001301
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001302 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1303 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1304 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001305 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001306 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00001307 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1308 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor575c63a2010-04-16 22:27:05 +00001309 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1310}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001311
1312/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001313/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001314bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1315 QualType &ResultTy) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001316 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1317 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001318
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001319 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1320 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1321 // - a pointer
1322 // - a member pointer
1323 // - a block pointer
1324 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1325 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1326 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1327 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1328 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1329 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1330 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1331 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1332 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1333 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1334 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1335 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1336 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1337 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1338 } else {
1339 return false;
1340 }
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001341
John McCall00ccbef2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00001342 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1343 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1344 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1345 return false;
1346 }
1347
1348 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1349 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1350 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1351
1352 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1353 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1354 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1355
1356 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001357 return true;
1358}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001359
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001360/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1361/// vector conversion.
1362///
1363/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1364/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001365static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1366 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001367 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1368 // conversion.
1369 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1370 return false;
1371
1372 // Identical types require no conversions.
1373 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1374 return false;
1375
1376 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1377 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1378 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1379 // identity conversion.
1380 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1381 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001382
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001383 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00001384 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001385 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1386 return true;
1387 }
1388 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001389
1390 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1391 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1392 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1393 // same size
1394 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1395 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001396 (Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions &&
Chandler Carruthc45eb9c2010-08-08 05:02:51 +00001397 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001398 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1399 return true;
1400 }
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001401 }
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001402
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001403 return false;
1404}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001405
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001406static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1407 bool InOverloadResolution,
1408 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1409 bool CStyle);
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001410
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001411/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1412/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1413/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1414/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1415/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1416/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1417/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1418/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001419static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1420 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001421 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001422 bool CStyle,
1423 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001424 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001425
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001426 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001427 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001428 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001429 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001430 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001431 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001432
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001433 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001434 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001435 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001436 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001437 return false;
1438
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001439 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001440 }
1441
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001442 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1443 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1444 // (C++ 4p1).
1445
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001446 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001447 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1448 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001449 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001450 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001451 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1452 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1453 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001454
1455 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1456 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1457 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1458 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1459 QualType resultTy;
1460 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001461 if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001462 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1463 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1464 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1465 return false;
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001466 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001467
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001468 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1469 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1470 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1471 // expression.
1472 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1473 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1474 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1475 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1476 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1477 == UO_AddrOf &&
1478 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1479 const Type *ClassType
1480 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1481 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruthfc5c8fc2011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001482 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1483 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1484 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001485 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1486 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1487 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001488
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001489 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001490 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1491 FromType,
1492 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregorad4e02f2010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001493 } else {
1494 return false;
1495 }
Anders Carlsson2bd62502010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001496 }
John McCall21480112011-08-30 00:57:29 +00001497 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1498 // A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1499 // be converted to a prvalue.
1500 bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001501 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001502 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001503 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001504 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001505
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001506 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1507 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1508 // of the type of the lvalue ...
1509 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1510 FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1511
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001512 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1513 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001514 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1515 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001516 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001517 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1518 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001519 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001520
1521 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1522 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1523 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001524 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001525
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001526 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001527 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001528 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001529
1530 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1531 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1532 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1533 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001534 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1535 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001536 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001537 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001538 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001539 }
John McCall7eb0a9e2010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001540 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001541 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001542 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001543
1544 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1545 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1546 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001547 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001548 } else {
1549 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001550 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001551 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001552 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001553
1554 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1555 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1556 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1557 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001558 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1559 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001560 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001561 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001562 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001563 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1564 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001565 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001566 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001567 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001568 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001569 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001570 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001571 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001572 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001573 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001574 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001575 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001576 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1577 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001578 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1579 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1580 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1581 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1582 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1583 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1584 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1585 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1586 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001587 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001588 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001589 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001590 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001591 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Richard Smith42860f12013-05-10 20:29:50 +00001592 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001593 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001594 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1595 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001596 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1597 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001598 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1599 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1600 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001601 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth23a370f2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001602 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1603 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1604 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001605 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001606 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001607 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor0c293ea2010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001608 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001609 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001610 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001611 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001612 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001613 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1614 } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1615 S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1616 SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001617 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1618 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001619 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001620 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001621 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00001622 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001623 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001624 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001625 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001626 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001627 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001628 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1629 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001630 } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001631 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001632 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001633 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregorfb4a5432010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001634 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00001635 } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001636 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1637 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001638 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1639 InOverloadResolution,
1640 SCS, CStyle)) {
1641 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1642 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00001643 } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1644 CStyle)) {
1645 // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00001646 // appropriately.
1647 return true;
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00001648 } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1649 From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1650 (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1651 SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1652 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001653 } else {
1654 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001655 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001656 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001657 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001658
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001659 QualType CanonFrom;
1660 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001661 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001662 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1663 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1664 ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001665 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001666 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001667 FromType = ToType;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001668 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1669 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001670 } else {
1671 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001672 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1673
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001674 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001675 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1676 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1677 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001678 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1679 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001680 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001681 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Matt Arsenault5509f372013-02-26 21:15:54 +00001682 CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001683 FromType = ToType;
1684 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1685 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001686 }
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001687 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001688
1689 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1690 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001691 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001692 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001693
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001694 return true;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001695}
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001696
1697static bool
1698IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1699 QualType &ToType,
1700 bool InOverloadResolution,
1701 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1702 bool CStyle) {
1703
1704 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1705 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1706 return false;
1707 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1708 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1709 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1710 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1711 itend = UD->field_end();
1712 it != itend; ++it) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001713 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1714 CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand97f5582011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001715 ToType = it->getType();
1716 return true;
1717 }
1718 }
1719 return false;
1720}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001721
1722/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1723/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1724/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1725/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001726bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001727 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlf7be9442008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001728 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001729 if (!To) {
1730 return false;
1731 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001732
1733 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1734 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1735 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1736 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1737 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregoraa74a1e2010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001738 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1739 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001740 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1741 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1742 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1743 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001744 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001745 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001746 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001747 }
1748
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001749 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1750 }
1751
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001752 // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001753 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1754 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1755 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1756 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1757 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001758 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001759 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001760 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001761 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1762 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001763 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001764 // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1765 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1766 // can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1767 // integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1768 // unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1769 // converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001770 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1771 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1772 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1773 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1774 return false;
1775
Richard Smithe7ff9192012-09-13 21:18:54 +00001776 // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1777 // even if that's not the promoted type.
1778 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1779 QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1780 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1781 IsIntegralPromotion(From, Underlying, ToType);
1782 }
1783
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001784 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001785 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00001786 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001787 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1788 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001789 }
John McCall842aef82009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001790
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001791 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001792 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1793 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1794 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001795 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001796 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001797 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001798 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001799 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001800 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregor0b8ddb92010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001801 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001802 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1803 // unsigned.
David Majnemer0ad92312011-07-22 21:09:04 +00001804 bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001805 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001806
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001807 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1808 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001809 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1810 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001811 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1812 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001813 };
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001814 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001815 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1816 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001817 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001818 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1819 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1820 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1821 // promotion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001822 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001823 }
1824 }
1825 }
1826
1827 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1828 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1829 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1830 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1831 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1832 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1833 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001834 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1835 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001836 using llvm::APSInt;
1837 if (From)
John McCall993f43f2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00001838 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001839 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001840 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001841 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1842 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1843 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001844
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001845 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1846 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1847 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1848 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1849 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001850
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001851 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1852 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1853 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1854 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1855 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001856
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001857 return false;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001858 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001859 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001860
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001861 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1862 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001863 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001864 return true;
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001865 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001866
1867 return false;
1868}
1869
1870/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1871/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1872/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001873bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001874 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1875 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001876 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1877 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001878 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1879 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1880 return true;
1881
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001882 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1883 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1884 // double is promoted to long double [...].
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00001885 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001886 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1887 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1888 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1889 return true;
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001890
1891 // Half can be promoted to float.
Joey Gouly19dbb202013-01-23 11:56:20 +00001892 if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1893 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
Anton Korobeynikovaa4a99b2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001894 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1895 return true;
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001896 }
1897
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001898 return false;
1899}
1900
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001901/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1902///
1903/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1904/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001905/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001906bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001907 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001908 if (!FromComplex)
1909 return false;
1910
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001911 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001912 if (!ToComplex)
1913 return false;
1914
1915 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregorb7b5d132009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001916 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1917 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1918 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor5cdf8212009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001919}
1920
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001921/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1922/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1923/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1924/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1925/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001926///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001927static QualType
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001928BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001929 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001930 ASTContext &Context,
1931 bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001932 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1933 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1934 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001935
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001936 /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1937 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Douglas Gregor143c7ac2010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001938 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001939
1940 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001941 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001942 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001943 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001944
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00001945 if (StripObjCLifetime)
1946 Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1947
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001948 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001949 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001950 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001951 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregoraf7bea52010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001952 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001953
1954 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1955 // already.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001956 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1957 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001958 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1959 }
1960
1961 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001962 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1963 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001964
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001965 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1966 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1967 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001968}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001969
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001970static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001971 bool InOverloadResolution,
1972 ASTContext &Context) {
1973 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1974 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1975 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001976 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001977 return !InOverloadResolution;
1978
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001979 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1980 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1981 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001982}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001983
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001984/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1985/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1986/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1987/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1988/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1989/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001990///
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001991/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1992/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1993/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1994/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1995/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1996/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001997/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1998/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1999/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002000bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson08972922009-08-28 15:33:32 +00002001 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002002 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002003 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002004 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002005 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2006 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002007 return true;
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00002008
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002009 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2010 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002011 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor27b09ac2008-12-22 20:51:52 +00002012 ConvertedType = ToType;
2013 return true;
2014 }
2015
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002016 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2017 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002018 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002019 ConvertedType = ToType;
2020 return true;
2021 }
2022 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2023 // pointer type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002024 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002025 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor071f2ae2008-11-27 00:15:41 +00002026 ConvertedType = ToType;
2027 return true;
2028 }
2029
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002030 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2031 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002032 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002033 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00002034 ConvertedType = ToType;
2035 return true;
2036 }
2037
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002038 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002039 if (!ToTypePtr)
2040 return false;
2041
2042 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlssonbbf306b2009-08-28 15:55:56 +00002043 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002044 ConvertedType = ToType;
2045 return true;
2046 }
Sebastian Redl07779722008-10-31 14:43:28 +00002047
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002048 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002049 // , including objective-c pointers.
2050 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002051 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002052 !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002053 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2054 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2055 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002056 ToType, Context);
2057 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianadcfab12009-12-16 23:13:33 +00002058 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002059 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002060 if (!FromTypePtr)
2061 return false;
2062
2063 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002064
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002065 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregor4e938f57b2010-08-18 21:25:30 +00002066 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2067 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2068 return false;
2069
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002070 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2071 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2072 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedman13578692010-08-05 02:49:48 +00002073 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2074 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002075 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002076 ToPointeeType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002077 ToType, Context,
2078 /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002079 return true;
2080 }
2081
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002082 // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002083 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
Francois Picheta8ef3ac2011-05-08 22:52:41 +00002084 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2085 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2086 ToPointeeType,
2087 ToType, Context);
2088 return true;
2089 }
2090
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002091 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2092 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002093 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002094 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002095 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002096 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002097 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002098 return true;
2099 }
2100
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002101 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002102 //
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002103 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2104 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2105 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2106 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2107 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2108 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2109 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2110 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
2111 //
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002112 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2113 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002114 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregorf9201e02009-02-11 23:02:49 +00002115 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregorbf1764c2010-02-22 17:06:41 +00002116 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002117 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002118 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002119 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbf408182008-11-27 00:52:49 +00002120 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002121 ToType, Context);
2122 return true;
2123 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002124
Fariborz Jahanian5da3c082011-04-14 20:33:36 +00002125 if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2126 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2127 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2128 ToPointeeType,
2129 ToType, Context);
2130 return true;
2131 }
2132
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002133 return false;
2134}
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002135
2136/// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2137static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2138 Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2139
2140 // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2141 if (TQs == Qs)
2142 return T;
2143
2144 if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2145 return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2146
2147 return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2148}
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002149
2150/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2151/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2152/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002154 QualType& ConvertedType,
2155 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002156 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002157 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002158
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002159 // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2160 Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2161
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002162 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002163 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2164 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002165 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002166 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002167
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002168 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002169 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2170 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2171 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2172 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2173 return false;
2174
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002175 // Check for compatible
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002176 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002177 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002178 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002179 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002180 return true;
2181 }
2182 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002183 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002184 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002185 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff4084c302009-07-23 01:01:38 +00002186 /*compare=*/false)) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002187 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002188 return true;
2189 }
2190 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
2191 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
2192 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002193 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2194 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002195 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
Fariborz Jahanianee9ca692010-03-15 18:36:00 +00002196 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2197 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2198 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002199 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002200 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2201 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002202 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002203 return true;
2204 }
2205
2206 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2207 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2208 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2209 // complain about it.
2210 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002211 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002212 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2213 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002214 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002215 return true;
2216 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002217 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002218 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002219 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002220 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002221 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002222 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002223 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002224 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002225 // to a block pointer type.
2226 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002227 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002228 return true;
2229 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002230 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianb351a7d2010-01-20 22:54:38 +00002231 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002232 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002233 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002234 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian48168392010-01-21 00:08:17 +00002235 // pointer to any object.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002236 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanianf7c43fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00002237 return true;
2238 }
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002239 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002240 return false;
2241
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002242 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002243 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002244 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002245 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2246 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002247 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2248 else
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002249 return false;
2250
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002251 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2252 // is an Objective-C conversion.
2253 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2254 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2255 IncompatibleObjC)) {
2256 // We always complain about this conversion.
2257 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002258 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002259 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002260 return true;
2261 }
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002262 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2263 // as in I* to id.
2264 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2265 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2266 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2267 IncompatibleObjC)) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002268
Douglas Gregorda80f742010-12-01 21:43:58 +00002269 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002270 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
Fariborz Jahanian83b7b312010-01-18 22:59:22 +00002271 return true;
2272 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002273
Douglas Gregor2a7e58d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00002274 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002275 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2276 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2277 // complain about it).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002278 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002279 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002280 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002281 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002282 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2283 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2284 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2285 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2286 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2287 return false;
2288
2289 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2290 // function types are obviously different.
2291 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2292 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2293 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2294 return false;
2295
2296 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2297 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
2298 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2299 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2300 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2301 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
2302 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2303 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2304 HasObjCConversion = true;
2305 } else {
2306 // Function types are too different. Abort.
2307 return false;
2308 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002309
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002310 // Check argument types.
2311 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2312 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2313 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2314 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2315 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2316 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2317 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2318 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2319 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2320 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2321 HasObjCConversion = true;
2322 } else {
2323 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2324 return false;
2325 }
2326 }
2327
2328 if (HasObjCConversion) {
2329 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2330 // conversion, but complain about it.
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00002331 ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
Douglas Gregorc7887512008-12-19 19:13:09 +00002332 IncompatibleObjC = true;
2333 return true;
2334 }
2335 }
2336
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002337 return false;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002338}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002339
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002340/// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2341/// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2342///
2343/// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2344///
2345/// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2346///
2347/// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2348/// this conversion.
2349bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2350 QualType &ConvertedType) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002351 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002352 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2353 return false;
2354
2355 // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2356 QualType ToPointee;
2357 if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2358 ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2359 else
2360 return false;
2361
2362 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2363 if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2364 ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
John McCall200fa532012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002365 !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002366 return false;
2367
2368 // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2369 QualType FromPointee;
2370 if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2371 FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2372 else
2373 return false;
2374
2375 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2376 if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2377 (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2378 FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2379 return false;
2380
2381 // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2382 FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2383 if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2384 return false;
2385
2386 // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2387 // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2388 // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2389 FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2390
2391 // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2392 ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2393 bool IncompatibleObjC;
2394 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2395 FromPointee = ToPointee;
2396 else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2397 IncompatibleObjC))
2398 return false;
2399
2400 /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2401 /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2402 FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2403 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2404 return true;
2405}
2406
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002407bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2408 QualType& ConvertedType) {
2409 QualType ToPointeeType;
2410 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2411 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2412 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2413 else
2414 return false;
2415
2416 QualType FromPointeeType;
2417 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2418 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2419 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2420 else
2421 return false;
2422 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2423 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2424 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2425
2426 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2427 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2428 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2429 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2430
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002431 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2432 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002433
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002434 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002435 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002436
2437 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2438 // function types are obviously different.
2439 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2440 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2441 return false;
2442
2443 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2444 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2445 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2446 return false;
2447
2448 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian462dae52011-02-13 20:11:42 +00002449 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2450 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002451 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2452 } else {
2453 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2454 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00002455 if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002456 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2457 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2458
2459 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2460 // OK exact match.
2461 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2462 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2463 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2464 return false;
2465 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2466 }
2467 else
2468 return false;
2469 }
2470
2471 // Check argument types.
2472 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2473 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2474 IncompatibleObjC = false;
2475 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2476 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2477 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2478 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2479 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2480 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2481 if (IncompatibleObjC)
2482 return false;
2483 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2484 } else
2485 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2486 return false;
2487 }
Fariborz Jahanian78213e42011-09-28 21:52:05 +00002488 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2489 !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2490 ToFunctionType))
2491 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianf9d95272011-09-28 20:22:05 +00002492
Fariborz Jahanian569bd8f2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00002493 ConvertedType = ToType;
2494 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniane3c8c642011-02-12 19:07:46 +00002495}
2496
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002497enum {
2498 ft_default,
2499 ft_different_class,
2500 ft_parameter_arity,
2501 ft_parameter_mismatch,
2502 ft_return_type,
2503 ft_qualifer_mismatch
2504};
2505
2506/// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2507/// function types. Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2508/// parameter types, and different return types.
2509void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2510 QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002511 // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2512 if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2513 PDiag << ft_default;
2514 return;
2515 }
2516
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002517 // Get the function type from the pointers.
2518 if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2519 const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2520 *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2521 if (FromMember->getClass() != ToMember->getClass()) {
2522 PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2523 << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2524 return;
2525 }
2526 FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2527 ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002528 }
2529
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002530 if (FromType->isPointerType())
2531 FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2532 if (ToType->isPointerType())
2533 ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2534
2535 // Remove references.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002536 FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2537 ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2538
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002539 // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2540 if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2541 !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2542 PDiag << ft_default;
2543 return;
2544 }
2545
Richard Trieua6dc7ef2011-12-13 23:19:45 +00002546 // No extra info for same types.
2547 if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2548 PDiag << ft_default;
2549 return;
2550 }
2551
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002552 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2553 *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2554
2555 // Both types need to be function types.
2556 if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2557 PDiag << ft_default;
2558 return;
2559 }
2560
2561 if (FromFunction->getNumArgs() != ToFunction->getNumArgs()) {
2562 PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumArgs()
2563 << FromFunction->getNumArgs();
2564 return;
2565 }
2566
2567 // Handle different parameter types.
2568 unsigned ArgPos;
2569 if (!FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2570 PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2571 << ToFunction->getArgType(ArgPos)
2572 << FromFunction->getArgType(ArgPos);
2573 return;
2574 }
2575
2576 // Handle different return type.
2577 if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getResultType(),
2578 ToFunction->getResultType())) {
2579 PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getResultType()
2580 << FromFunction->getResultType();
2581 return;
2582 }
2583
2584 unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2585 ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2586 if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2587 PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2588 return;
2589 }
2590
2591 // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2592 PDiag << ft_default;
2593}
2594
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002595/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
Douglas Gregordec1cc42011-12-15 17:15:07 +00002596/// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
Eli Friedman06017002013-06-18 22:41:37 +00002597/// they have same number of arguments. If the parameters are different,
2598/// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002599bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00002600 const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2601 unsigned *ArgPos) {
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002602 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2603 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2604 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
Richard Trieu7ea491c2013-08-09 21:42:32 +00002605 if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2606 N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
Larisse Voufo3151b7c2013-08-06 03:57:41 +00002607 if (ArgPos) *ArgPos = O - OldType->arg_type_begin();
2608 return false;
Fariborz Jahaniand8d34412010-05-03 21:06:18 +00002609 }
2610 }
2611 return true;
2612}
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002613
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002614/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2615/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00002616/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002617/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2618/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2619/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002620bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002621 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002622 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002623 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002624 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb3358722010-09-28 14:54:11 +00002625 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002626
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002627 Kind = CK_BitCast;
2628
David Blaikie50800fc2012-08-08 17:33:31 +00002629 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2630 From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2631 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2632 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2633 DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2634 PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2635 << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2636 else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2637 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2638 << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2639 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002640 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2641 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002642 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2643 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregordda78892008-12-18 23:43:31 +00002644
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00002645 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2646 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002647 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2648 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002649 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2650 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002651 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002652 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002653 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002654
Anders Carlsson61faec12009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002655 // The conversion was successful.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002656 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002657 }
2658 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002659 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2660 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2661 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2662 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002663 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2664 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2665 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002666 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002667 return false;
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002668 } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2669 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2670 } else {
2671 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002672 }
John McCall1d9b3b22011-09-09 05:25:32 +00002673 } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2674 if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2675 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002676 }
John McCalldaa8e4e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002677
2678 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2679 // reasons.
2680 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2681 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2682
Douglas Gregor94b1dd22008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002683 return false;
2684}
2685
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002686/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2687/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2688/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2689/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2690/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2691bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002692 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002693 bool InOverloadResolution,
2694 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002695 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002696 if (!ToTypePtr)
2697 return false;
2698
2699 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002700 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2701 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2702 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002703 ConvertedType = ToType;
2704 return true;
2705 }
2706
2707 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002708 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002709 if (!FromTypePtr)
2710 return false;
2711
2712 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2713 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2714 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2715 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002716
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002717 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00002718 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorcfddf7b2010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002719 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002720 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2721 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2722 return true;
2723 }
2724
2725 return false;
2726}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002727
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002728/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2729/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002730/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002731/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2732/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2733/// otherwise.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002734bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002735 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002736 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redla82e4ae2009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002737 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002738 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002739 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002740 if (!FromPtrType) {
2741 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002742 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002743 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002744 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002745 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002746 return false;
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002747 }
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002748
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002749 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002750 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2751 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002752
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002753 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2754 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002755
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002756 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2757 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2758 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002759
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002760 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregora8f32e02009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002761 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002762 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2763 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2764 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2765 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002766
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002767 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2768 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002769 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2770 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2771 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2772 return true;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002773 }
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002774
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002775 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002776 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2777 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2778 << From->getSourceRange();
2779 return true;
2780 }
2781
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002782 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall58e6f342010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002783 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2784 Paths.front(),
2785 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall6b2accb2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002786
Anders Carlsson27a5b9b2009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002787 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlssonf9d68e12010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002788 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002789 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl4433aaf2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002790 return false;
2791}
2792
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002793/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2794/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2795/// (C++ 4.4).
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002796///
2797/// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2798/// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2799/// object lifetime.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002800bool
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002801Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002802 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002803 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2804 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002805 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2806
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002807 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2808 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redl22c92402010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002809 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002810 return false;
Sebastian Redl21593ac2009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002811
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002812 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2813 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2814 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2815 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002816 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002817 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002818 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2819 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2820 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002821 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002822 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2823 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002824 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002825
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002826 Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2827 Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2828
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002829 // Objective-C ARC:
2830 // Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2831 if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2832 UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2833 if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2834 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2835 FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2836 ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2837 } else {
2838 // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2839 // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2840 return false;
2841 }
2842 }
2843
Douglas Gregor377e1bd2011-05-08 06:09:53 +00002844 // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2845 if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2846 (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2847 FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2848 ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2849 }
2850
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002851 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2852 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002853 if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002854 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002855
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002856 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2857 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002858 if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002859 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002860 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002861
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002862 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2863 // include const.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002864 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor621c92a2011-04-25 18:40:17 +00002865 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002866 }
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002867
2868 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2869 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2870 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2871 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2872 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002873 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002874}
2875
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002876/// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2877/// atomic type.
2878///
2879/// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2880/// sequence to finish the conversion.
Douglas Gregor7d000652012-04-12 20:48:09 +00002881static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2882 bool InOverloadResolution,
2883 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2884 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregorf7ecc302012-04-12 17:51:55 +00002885 const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2886 if (!ToAtomic)
2887 return false;
2888
2889 StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2890 if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2891 InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2892 CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2893 return false;
2894
2895 SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2896 SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2897 SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2898 SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2899 = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2900 SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2901 return true;
2902}
2903
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002904static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2905 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2906 QualType Type) {
2907 const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2908 Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2909 if (CtorType->getNumArgs() > 0) {
2910 QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getArgType(0);
2911 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2912 return true;
2913 }
2914 return false;
2915}
2916
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002917static OverloadingResult
2918IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2919 CXXRecordDecl *To,
2920 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2921 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2922 bool AllowExplicit) {
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00002923 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2924 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002925 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2926 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2927 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2928
2929 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2930 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2931 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2932 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2933 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2934 Constructor
2935 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2936 else
2937 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2938
2939 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2940 S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2941 (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2942 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002943 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2944 // suppress conversions.
2945 bool SuppressUserConversions =
2946 isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002947 if (ConstructorTmpl)
2948 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2949 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002950 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002951 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002952 else
2953 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00002954 From, CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00002955 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002956 }
2957 }
2958
2959 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2960
2961 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2962 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2963 case OR_Success: {
2964 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2965 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00002966 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2967 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
2968 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
2969 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2970 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2971 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2972 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2973 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2974 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2975 return OR_Success;
2976 }
2977
2978 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2979 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2980 case OR_Deleted:
2981 return OR_Deleted;
2982 case OR_Ambiguous:
2983 return OR_Ambiguous;
2984 }
2985
2986 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
2987}
2988
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002989/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2990/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2991/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2992/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2993/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2994/// false and User is unspecified.
2995///
Douglas Gregor734d9862009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002996/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2997/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2998/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00002999///
3000/// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3001/// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3002/// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003003static OverloadingResult
3004IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003005 UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3006 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003007 bool AllowExplicit,
3008 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3009 assert(!AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3010
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003011 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3012 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3013
3014 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3015 // constructors.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003016 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003017 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3018 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3019 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3020 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3021 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3022 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3023 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3024 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003025 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003026 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003027 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003028 ConstructorsOnly = true;
3029
Benjamin Kramer63b6ebe2012-11-23 17:04:52 +00003030 S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidise36bca62011-04-22 17:45:37 +00003031 // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3032 // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3033 // to try to recover.
3034 if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
Douglas Gregor393896f2009-11-05 13:06:35 +00003035 // We're not going to find any constructors.
3036 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3037 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003038
3039 Expr **Args = &From;
3040 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3041 bool ListInitializing = false;
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003042 if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Benjamin Kramere5753592013-09-09 14:48:42 +00003043 // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
Sebastian Redl56a04282012-02-11 23:51:08 +00003044 OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3045 S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3046 if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3047 return Result;
3048 // Never mind.
3049 CandidateSet.clear();
3050
3051 // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3052 // arguments, not the entire list.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003053 Args = InitList->getInits();
3054 NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3055 ListInitializing = true;
3056 }
3057
David Blaikie3bc93e32012-12-19 00:45:41 +00003058 DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3059 for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003060 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003061 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3062 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3063
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003064 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3065 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
3066 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003067 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003068 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003069 Constructor
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003070 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3071 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003072 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003073
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003074 bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3075 if (ListInitializing)
3076 Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3077 else
3078 Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3079 if (Usable) {
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003080 bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3081 if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3082 SuppressUserConversions = false;
3083 if (NumArgs == 1) {
3084 // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3085 // suppress conversions.
Sebastian Redlf78c0f92012-03-27 18:33:03 +00003086 SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3087 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003088 }
3089 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003090 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003091 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3092 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003093 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003094 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003095 else
Fariborz Jahanian249cead2009-10-01 20:39:51 +00003096 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3097 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003098 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003099 llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
Sebastian Redl1cd89c42012-03-20 21:24:14 +00003100 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +00003101 }
Douglas Gregorc1efaec2009-02-28 01:32:25 +00003102 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003103 }
3104 }
3105
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003106 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003107 if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003108 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00003109 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003110 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003111 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003112 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003113 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3114 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00003115 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
3116 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
3117 Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3118 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
3119 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003120 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3121 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003122 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3123 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3124 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3125
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003126 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3127 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003128 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3129 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003130 else
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00003131 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003132
3133 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3134 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003135 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3136 ActingContext, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003137 CandidateSet,
3138 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003139 else
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003140 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003141 From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3142 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Fariborz Jahanian8664ad52009-09-11 18:46:22 +00003143 }
3144 }
3145 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00003146 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003147
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003148 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3149
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003150 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003151 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003152 case OR_Success:
3153 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3154 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3155 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3156 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3157 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3158 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3159 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3160 // the argument of the constructor.
3161 //
3162 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00003163 if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3164 // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3165 User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3166 } else {
3167 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3168 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3169 else {
3170 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3171 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3172 }
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003173 }
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003174 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003175 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003176 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003177 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3178 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3179 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3180 return OR_Success;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003181 }
3182 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003183 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3184 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3185 //
3186 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3187 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3188 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3189 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3190 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00003191 User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003192 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00003193 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003194 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003195
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003196 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3197 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3198 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3199 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3200 // is an initialization, the special rules for
3201 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3202 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3203 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3204 // 13.3.3.1).
3205 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3206 return OR_Success;
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003207 }
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003208 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003209
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003210 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3211 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3212 case OR_Deleted:
3213 // No conversion here! We're done.
3214 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003215
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003216 case OR_Ambiguous:
3217 return OR_Ambiguous;
3218 }
3219
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003220 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003221}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003222
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003223bool
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003224Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003225 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +00003226 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003227 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003228 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00003229 CandidateSet, false, false);
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003230 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00003231 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003232 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3233 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
Larisse Voufo7419d012013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003234 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
Larisse Voufo288f76a2013-06-27 03:36:30 +00003235 if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
Larisse Voufo7419d012013-06-27 01:50:25 +00003236 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3237 From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3238 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
3239 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3240 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3241 }
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003242 else
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003243 return false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00003244 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003245 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003246}
Douglas Gregor60d62c22008-10-31 16:23:19 +00003247
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003248/// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3249/// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3250/// is possible.
3251static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3252compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S,
3253 FunctionDecl *Function1,
3254 FunctionDecl *Function2) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00003255 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003256 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3257
3258 // Objective-C++:
3259 // If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3260 // a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3261 // respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3262 // because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3263 // to keep code working.
3264 CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3265 if (!Conv1)
3266 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3267
3268 CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3269 if (!Conv2)
3270 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3271
3272 if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3273 bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3274 bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3275 if (Block1 != Block2)
3276 return Block1? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3277 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3278 }
3279
3280 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3281}
3282
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003283/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3284/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3285/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003286static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3287CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3288 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3289 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003290{
3291 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3292 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3293 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3294 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3295 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3296 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3297 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3298 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003299 //
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003300 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3301 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3302 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3303 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3304 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003305 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3306 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00003307 if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003308 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003309
Benjamin Kramerb6eee072010-04-18 12:05:54 +00003310 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3311 // the same kind.
3312 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3313 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3314
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003315 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3316 ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3317
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003318 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3319 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3320 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003321 if (ICS1.isStandard())
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003322 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3323 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003324 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003325 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3326 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3327 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3328 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3329 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3330 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003331 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003332 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003333 Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3334 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3335 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00003336 else
3337 Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3338 ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3339 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003340 }
3341
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003342 // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3343 // list-initialization sequence L2 if L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X>
3344 // for some X and L2 does not.
3345 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable &&
Richard Smith798186a2013-09-06 22:30:28 +00003346 !ICS1.isBad()) {
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00003347 if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3348 !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3349 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3350 if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3351 ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3352 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00003353 }
3354
3355 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003356}
3357
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003358static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3359 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3360 Qualifiers Quals;
3361 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003362 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003363 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003364
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003365 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3366}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003367
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003368// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3369// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3370static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3371compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3372 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3373 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3374 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3375 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3376
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003377 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregorae65f4b2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00003378 // any non-identity conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor4ae5b722011-06-05 06:15:20 +00003379 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3380 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3381 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3382 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003383
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003384 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3385 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3386 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3387 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3388 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3389 else
3390 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor5a57efd2010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003391 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003392 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3393
3394 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3395 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3396 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3397 }
3398
3399 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3400 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3401 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3402 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3403
3404 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3405 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3406 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3407 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003408
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003409 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3410}
3411
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003412/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3413/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3414static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3415 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3416 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3417 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3418 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003419 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003420 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003421 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003422 // reference*.
3423 //
3424 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3425 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3426 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3427 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3428 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003429 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3430 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3431 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003432
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003433 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3434 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3435 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3436 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
3437}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003438
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003439/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3440/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3441/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003442static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3443CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3444 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3445 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003446{
3447 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3448 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3449
3450 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3451 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3452 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3453 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3454 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003455 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003456 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003457 return CK;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003458
3459 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3460 // defined below), or, if not that,
3461 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3462 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3463 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3464 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3465 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3466 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003467
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003468 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3469 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3470 // applies:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003471
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003472 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3473 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3474 // that is such a conversion.
3475 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3476 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3477 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3478 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3479
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003480 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3481 //
3482 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003483 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3484 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3485 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003486 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003487 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003488 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003489 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003490 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3491 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3492 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003493 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3494 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003495 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3496 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3497 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003498 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003499 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003500 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003501 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3502 !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003503 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3504 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3505 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003506 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3507 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003508
3509 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3510 // conversion, if we need to.
3511 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003512 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003513 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003514 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003515
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003516 QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3517 QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003518
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003519 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003520 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003521 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003522 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3523
3524 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3525 // other, it is the better one.
Douglas Gregor0f7b3dc2011-04-27 00:01:52 +00003526 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3527 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3528 const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3529 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3530 if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3531 bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3532 FromObjCPtr2);
3533 bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3534 FromObjCPtr1);
3535 if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3536 return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3537 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3538 }
Douglas Gregor01919692009-12-13 21:37:05 +00003539 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003540 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003541
3542 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3543 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003544 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003545 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003546 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003547
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003548 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003549 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3550 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3551 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3552 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3553 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003554
Sebastian Redlf2e21e52009-03-22 23:49:27 +00003555 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3556 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3557 // which the references refer are the same type except for
3558 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3559 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3560 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003561 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3562 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003563 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3564 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003565 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003566 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3567 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003568 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003569 // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3570 // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3571 if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3572 SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3573 return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3574 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3575 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3576 }
3577
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003578 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3579 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003580 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003581 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003582 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003583 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003584 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3585 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3586 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003587 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003588 }
3589 }
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003590
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003591 // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3592 // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3593 // is between types of the same size.
3594 // For example:
3595 // void f(float);
3596 // void f(int);
3597 // int main {
3598 // long a;
3599 // f(a);
3600 // }
3601 // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3602 // as clang will do in standard mode.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003603 if (S.getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode &&
Francois Pichet1c98d622011-09-18 21:37:37 +00003604 SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3605 SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3606 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3607 S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3608 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3609
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003610 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3611}
3612
3613/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3614/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003615/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3616ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003617CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3618 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3619 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregorba7e2102008-10-22 15:04:37 +00003620 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003621 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3622 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3623 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3624 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3625 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3626 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3627 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3628 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3629
3630 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3631 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003632 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3633 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003634 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3635 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003636 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003637 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3638 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003639
3640 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3641 // them.
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003642 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003643 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3644
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003645 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3646 // for comparison.
3647 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003648 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003649 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003650 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth28e318c2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003651
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003652 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003653 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003654
3655 // Objective-C++ ARC:
3656 // Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3657 // to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3658 if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3659 SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3660 Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3661 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3662 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3663 }
3664
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003665 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003666 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3667 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3668 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregorf8268ae2008-10-22 17:49:05 +00003669 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003670 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3671 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3672 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3673 // strict subset of qualifiers.
3674 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3675 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3676 // about how the sequences rank.
3677 ;
3678 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3679 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3680 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3681 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3682 // qualifiers.
3683 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003684
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003685 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3686 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3687 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3688 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3689 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3690 // qualifiers.
3691 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003692
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003693 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3694 } else {
3695 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3696 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3697 }
3698
3699 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003700 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003701 break;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003702 }
3703
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003704 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3705 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3706 switch (Result) {
3707 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003708 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003709 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3710 break;
3711
3712 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3713 break;
3714
3715 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregora9bff302010-02-28 18:30:25 +00003716 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregor57373262008-10-22 14:17:15 +00003717 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3718 break;
3719 }
3720
3721 return Result;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003722}
3723
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003724/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3725/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003726/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3727/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
3728/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003729ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003730CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3731 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3732 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003733 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003734 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003735 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003736 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003737
3738 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3739 // conversion, if we need to.
3740 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003741 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003742 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003743 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003744
3745 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003746 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3747 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3748 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3749 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003750
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003751 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003752 //
3753 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3754 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003755 //
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003756 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003757 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregor7ca09762008-11-27 01:19:21 +00003758 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3759 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3760 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3761 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003762 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003763 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003764 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003765 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003766 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003767 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003768 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003769 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregorcb7de522008-11-26 23:31:11 +00003770
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003771 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003772 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003773 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003774 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003775 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003776 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3777 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003778
3779 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3780 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003781 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003782 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003783 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003784 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003785 }
3786 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3787 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3788 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3789 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3790 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3791 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3792 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3793 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3794 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3795 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3796
3797 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3798 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3799 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3800 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3801 // Objective-C pointer types.
3802 bool FromAssignLeft
3803 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3804 bool FromAssignRight
3805 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3806 bool ToAssignLeft
3807 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3808 bool ToAssignRight
3809 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3810
3811 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3812 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3813 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3814 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3815 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3816 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3817 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3818 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3819
3820 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3821 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3822 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3823 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3824 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3825 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3826
3827 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3828 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3829 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3830 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3831 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3832 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3833 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3834 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3835
3836 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3837 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3838 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3839 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3840 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3841 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003842
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003843 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3844 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3845 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3846 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3847 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3848 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3849
3850 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3851 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3852 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3853 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3854 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003855 }
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003856 }
Douglas Gregor395cc372011-01-31 18:51:41 +00003857
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003858 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003859 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3860 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3861 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003862 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003863 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003864 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003865 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003866 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003867 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003868 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003869 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3870 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3871 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3872 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3873 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3874 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3875 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3876 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3877 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian2357da02009-10-20 20:07:35 +00003878 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003879 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003880 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003881 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003882 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003883 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3884 }
3885 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3886 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003887 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003888 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003889 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian8577c982009-10-20 20:04:46 +00003890 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3891 }
3892 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003893
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00003894 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003895 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003896 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3897 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3898 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003899 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3900 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3901 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003902 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003903 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003904 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3905 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003906
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003907 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor9e239322010-02-25 19:01:05 +00003908 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3909 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3910 // reference of type A&,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003911 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3912 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3913 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003914 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003915 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003916 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3917 }
3918 }
Douglas Gregorf70bdb92008-10-29 14:50:44 +00003919
Douglas Gregorbc0805a2008-10-23 00:40:37 +00003920 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3921}
3922
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003923/// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3924/// C++ class.
3925static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3926 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3927 return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3928
3929 return true;
3930}
3931
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003932/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3933/// determine whether they are reference-related,
3934/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3935/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3936/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3937/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3938/// type being initialized.
3939Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3940Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3941 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003942 bool &DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003943 bool &ObjCConversion,
3944 bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003945 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3946 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3947 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3948
3949 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3950 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3951 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3952 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3953 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3954
3955 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3956 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3957 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3958 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003959 DerivedToBase = false;
3960 ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003961 ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003962 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3963 // Nothing to do.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00003964 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor0162c1c2013-03-26 23:36:30 +00003965 isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
3966 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003967 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003968 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3969 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3970 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3971 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003972 else
3973 return Ref_Incompatible;
3974
3975 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3976 // least).
3977
3978 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3979 // for comparison.
3980 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3981 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3982 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3983 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3984
3985 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3986 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3987 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3988 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3989 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3990 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3991 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00003992 //
3993 // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3994 // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3995 // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3996 // space 2.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00003997 if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3998 T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3999 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4000 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4001 ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4002 }
4003
Douglas Gregora6ce3e62011-04-28 17:56:11 +00004004 if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004005 return Ref_Compatible;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004006 else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004007 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4008 else
4009 return Ref_Related;
4010}
4011
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004012/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004013/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4014static bool
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004015FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4016 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4017 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4018 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004019 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4020 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4021 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4022
4023 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00004024 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
4025 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
4026 Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4027 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
4028 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004029 NamedDecl *D = *I;
4030 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4031 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4032 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4033
4034 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4035 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4036 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4037 if (ConvTemplate)
4038 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4039 else
4040 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4041
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004042 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004043 // explicit conversions, skip it.
4044 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4045 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004046
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004047 if (AllowRvalues) {
4048 bool DerivedToBase = false;
4049 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004050 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004051
4052 // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4053 // functions that return lvalues.
4054 if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4055 const ReferenceType *RefType
4056 = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4057 if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4058 continue;
4059 }
4060
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004061 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004062 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4063 DeclLoc,
4064 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4065 .getUnqualifiedType(),
4066 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004067 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004068 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004069 continue;
4070 } else {
4071 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4072 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4073 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4074
4075 const ReferenceType *RefType =
4076 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4077 if (!RefType ||
4078 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4079 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4080 continue;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004081 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004082
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004083 if (ConvTemplate)
4084 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004085 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4086 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004087 else
4088 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004089 DeclType, CandidateSet,
4090 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004091 }
4092
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004093 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4094
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004095 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00004096 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004097 case OR_Success:
4098 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4099 //
4100 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4101 // applying a conversion function to the argument
4102 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4103 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4104 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4105 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4106 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4107 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4108 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4109 return false;
4110
4111 ICS.setUserDefined();
4112 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4113 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00004114 ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004115 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00004116 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004117 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4118 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4119 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4120 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4121 return true;
4122
4123 case OR_Ambiguous:
4124 ICS.setAmbiguous();
4125 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4126 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4127 if (Cand->Viable)
4128 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4129 return true;
4130
4131 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4132 case OR_Deleted:
4133 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4134 // conversion; continue with other checks.
4135 return false;
4136 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004137
David Blaikie7530c032012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004138 llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004139}
4140
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004141/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4142/// initialization.
4143static ImplicitConversionSequence
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004144TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004145 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4146 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00004147 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004148 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4149
4150 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4151 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4152 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4153
4154 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4155 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4156
4157 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4158 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4159 // type of the resulting function.
4160 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4161 DeclAccessPair Found;
4162 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4163 false, Found))
4164 T2 = Fn->getType();
4165 }
4166
4167 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4168 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4169 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004170 bool ObjCConversion = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004171 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004172 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004173 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004174 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004175 ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004176
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004177
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004178 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004179 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4180 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4181
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004182 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004183 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004184 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4185 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4186 //
4187 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4188 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4189 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004190 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004191 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4192 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4193 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4194 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4195 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4196 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4197 ICS.setStandard();
4198 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor569c3162010-08-07 11:51:51 +00004199 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4200 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4201 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004202 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4203 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4204 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4205 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4206 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4207 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4208 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004209 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4210 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4211 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004212 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004213 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004214 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004215
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004216 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4217 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4218 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4219 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004220 return ICS;
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004221 }
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004222
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004223 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4224 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4225 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4226 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4227 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4228 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4229 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4230 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004231 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004232 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor604eb652010-08-11 02:15:33 +00004233 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4234 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4235 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004236 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004237 }
4238 }
4239
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004240 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4241 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004242 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004243 //
Douglas Gregor66821b52010-04-18 09:22:00 +00004244 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
4245 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
4246 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
4247 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
4248 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
4249 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
4250 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redl4680bf22010-06-30 18:13:39 +00004251 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
4252 // go together.
Richard Smith8ab10aa2012-05-24 04:29:20 +00004253 if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004254 return ICS;
4255
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004256 // -- If the initializer expression
4257 //
4258 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004259 // lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004260 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4261 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4262 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4263 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4264 ICS.setStandard();
4265 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004266 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004267 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4268 : ICK_Identity;
4269 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4270 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4271 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4272 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4273 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4274 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4275 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4276 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4277 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4278 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4279 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004280 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004281 S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004282 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004283 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4284 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004285 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004286 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004287 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004288 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004289 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004290 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004291
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004292 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4293 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004294 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4295 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004296 // "cv3 T3",
4297 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004298 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004299 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004300 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004301 // class subobject).
4302 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004303 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004304 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4305 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4306 AllowExplicit)) {
4307 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4308 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4309 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4310 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004311 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregor8dde14e2011-01-24 16:14:37 +00004312 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4313 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4314
Douglas Gregor68ed68b2011-01-21 16:36:05 +00004315 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolaaa5952c2011-01-22 15:32:35 +00004316 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004317
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004318 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4319 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
4320 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4321 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4322 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4323 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4324 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4325 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4326 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4327 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4328 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4329 // initialization fails.
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004330 //
4331 // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4332 // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4333 Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4334 Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4335 T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4336 T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4337 T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4338 T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4339 if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4340 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004341 }
4342
4343 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4344 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4345 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4346 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4347 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4348 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4349 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4350 return ICS;
4351
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004352 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4353 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4354 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4355 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4356 return ICS;
4357
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004358 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004359 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4360 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4361 // required to convert the argument expression to the
4362 // underlying type of the reference according to
4363 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4364 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4365 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4366 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4367 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004368 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4369 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004370 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004371 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004372 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4373 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004374
4375 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4376 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4377 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004378 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4379 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4380 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004381 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004382 ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004383 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor203050c2011-10-04 23:59:32 +00004384 // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
4385 if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4386 if (const ReferenceType *RefType
4387 = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
4388 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
4389 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
4390 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
4391 DeclType);
4392 return ICS;
4393 }
4394 }
4395 }
4396
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004397 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregorf20d2722011-08-15 13:59:46 +00004398 ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4399 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4400 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
4401 ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4402 ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004403 }
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004404
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004405 return ICS;
4406}
4407
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004408static ImplicitConversionSequence
4409TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4410 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4411 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004412 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4413 bool AllowExplicit = false);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004414
4415/// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4416/// initializer list From.
4417static ImplicitConversionSequence
4418TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4419 bool SuppressUserConversions,
4420 bool InOverloadResolution,
4421 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4422 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4423 // When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4424 // special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4425
4426 ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4427 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4428
Sebastian Redlb832f6d2012-01-23 22:09:39 +00004429 // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004430 // initialized from init lists.
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00004431 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004432 return Result;
4433
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004434 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4435 // If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4436 // all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4437 // conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4438 // element of the list to X.
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004439 bool toStdInitializerList = false;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004440 QualType X;
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004441 if (ToType->isArrayType())
Richard Smith2801d9a2012-12-09 06:48:56 +00004442 X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004443 else
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004444 toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004445 if (!X.isNull()) {
4446 for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4447 Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4448 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4449 TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4450 InOverloadResolution,
4451 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4452 // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4453 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4454 Result = ICS;
4455 break;
4456 }
4457 // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4458 if (Result.isBad() ||
4459 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4460 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4461 Result = ICS;
4462 }
Douglas Gregor5b4bf132012-04-04 23:09:20 +00004463
4464 // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4465 // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4466 if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4467 Result.setStandard();
4468 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4469 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4470 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4471 }
4472
Sebastian Redladfb5352012-02-27 22:38:26 +00004473 Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004474 return Result;
Sebastian Redlfe592282012-01-17 22:49:48 +00004475 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004476
4477 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4478 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4479 // resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4480 // conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4481 // constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4482 // implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004483 if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4484 // This function can deal with initializer lists.
Richard Smith798186a2013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004485 return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4486 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4487 InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004488 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4489 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Sebastian Redlcf15cef2011-12-22 18:58:38 +00004490 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004491
4492 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4493 // Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4494 // initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4495 // sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004496 if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004497 // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4498 // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4499 // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4500 InitializedEntity Entity =
4501 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4502 /*Consumed=*/false);
4503 if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, S.Owned(From))) {
4504 Result.setUserDefined();
4505 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4506 // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4507 Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4508 Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4509
4510 Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4511 Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4512 Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Benjamin Kramer83db10e2012-02-02 19:35:29 +00004513 Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = 0;
Sebastian Redlcc7a6482011-11-01 15:53:09 +00004514 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004515 return Result;
4516 }
4517
4518 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4519 // Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004520 if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4521 // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4522 // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4523 // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4524
4525 QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4526
4527 // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4528 // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4529 if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4530 Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4531
4532 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4533
4534 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4535 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4536 // type of the resulting function.
4537 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4538 DeclAccessPair Found;
4539 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4540 Init, ToType, false, Found))
4541 T2 = Fn->getType();
4542 }
4543
4544 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4545 bool dummy1 = false;
4546 bool dummy2 = false;
4547 bool dummy3 = false;
4548 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4549 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4550 dummy2, dummy3);
4551
Richard Smith3082be22013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004552 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
Richard Smith798186a2013-09-06 22:30:28 +00004553 return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4554 SuppressUserConversions,
4555 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Richard Smith3082be22013-09-06 01:22:42 +00004556 }
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004557 }
4558
4559 // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4560 // initializer list.
4561 Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4562 InOverloadResolution,
4563 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4564 if (Result.isFailure())
4565 return Result;
4566 assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4567 "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4568
4569 // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4570 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4571 (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4572 StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4573 Result.UserDefined.After;
4574 SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4575 SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4576 SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4577 SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4578 SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4579 SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4580 } else
4581 Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4582 From, ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004583 return Result;
Sebastian Redl1cdb70b2011-12-03 14:54:30 +00004584 }
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004585
4586 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4587 // Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4588 if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4589 // - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
4590 // sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
4591 // parameter type.
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004592 unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4593 if (NumInits == 1)
4594 Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4595 SuppressUserConversions,
4596 InOverloadResolution,
4597 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4598 // - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4599 // sequence is the identity conversion.
4600 else if (NumInits == 0) {
4601 Result.setStandard();
4602 Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCalle14ba2c2012-04-04 02:40:27 +00004603 Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4604 Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004605 }
4606 return Result;
4607 }
4608
4609 // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4610 // In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4611 return Result;
4612}
4613
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004614/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4615/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4616/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4617/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00004618/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregor74e386e2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00004619/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004620static ImplicitConversionSequence
4621TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004622 bool SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004623 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004624 bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4625 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redl5405b812011-10-16 18:19:34 +00004626 if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4627 return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4628 InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4629
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004630 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004631 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004632 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4633 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00004634 AllowExplicit);
Douglas Gregorabe183d2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00004635
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004636 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4637 SuppressUserConversions,
4638 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004639 InOverloadResolution,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004640 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004641 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4642 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor27c8dc02008-10-29 00:13:59 +00004643}
4644
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00004645static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4646 const CanQualType ToQTy,
4647 Sema &S,
4648 SourceLocation Loc,
4649 ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4650 OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4651 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4652 TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4653
4654 return !ICS.isBad();
4655}
4656
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004657/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4658/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4659/// expression @p From.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004660static ImplicitConversionSequence
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004661TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004662 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004663 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4664 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4665 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl65bdbfa2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00004666 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4667 // const volatile object.
4668 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4669 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004670 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004671
4672 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4673 // to exit early.
4674 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004675
4676 // We need to have an object of class type.
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004677 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004678 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4679
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004680 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4681 // better have an lvalue.
4682 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4683 }
4684
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004685 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004686
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004687 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004688 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004689 // parameter is
4690 //
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00004691 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4692 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4693 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004694 // ref-qualifier
4695 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004696 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004697 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4698 //
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004699 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004700 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004701 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4702 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4703 // non-constant references.
4704
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004705 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004706 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004707 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004708 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004709 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004710 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
Richard Smith98bfbf52013-01-26 02:07:32 +00004711 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004712 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004713 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004714
4715 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4716 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004717 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004718 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4719 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4720 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004721 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004722 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004723 else {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004724 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4725 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004726 return ICS;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004727 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004728
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004729 // Check the ref-qualifier.
4730 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4731 case RQ_None:
4732 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4733 break;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004734
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004735 case RQ_LValue:
4736 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4737 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004738 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004739 ImplicitParamType);
4740 return ICS;
4741 }
4742 break;
4743
4744 case RQ_RValue:
4745 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4746 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004747 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004748 ImplicitParamType);
4749 return ICS;
4750 }
4751 break;
4752 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004753
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004754 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004755 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00004756 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4757 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004758 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004759 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004760 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4761 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004762 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregor440a4832011-01-26 14:52:12 +00004763 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregorfcab48b2011-01-26 19:41:18 +00004764 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4765 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4766 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004767 return ICS;
4768}
4769
4770/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4771/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4772/// expression.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004773ExprResult
4774Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004775 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00004776 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004777 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004778 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004779 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004780 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004781
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004782 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004783 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004784 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4785 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004786 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004787 } else {
4788 FromRecordType = From->getType();
4789 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004790 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004791 }
4792
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004793 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4794 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004795 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004796 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4797 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004798 if (ICS.isBad()) {
4799 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4800 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4801 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4802 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4803 if (CVR) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004804 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004805 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4806 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4807 << From->getSourceRange();
4808 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4809 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004810 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004811 }
4812 }
4813
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004814 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004815 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssona552f7c2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00004816 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis64ccf242010-11-16 08:04:45 +00004817 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004818
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004819 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4820 ExprResult FromRes =
4821 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4822 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4823 return ExprError();
4824 From = FromRes.take();
4825 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004826
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00004827 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004828 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
Richard Smithacdfa4d2011-11-10 23:32:36 +00004829 From->getValueKind()).take();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004830 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004831}
4832
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004833/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4834/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004835static ImplicitConversionSequence
4836TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004837 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonda7a18b2009-08-27 17:24:15 +00004838 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004839 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor14d0aee2011-01-27 00:58:17 +00004840 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00004841 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00004842 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4843 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004844}
4845
4846/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4847/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004848ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00004849 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4850 return ExprError();
4851
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004852 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004853 if (!ICS.isBad())
4854 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004855
Fariborz Jahaniancc5306a2009-11-18 18:26:29 +00004856 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004857 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00004858 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
Fariborz Jahanian17c7a5d2009-09-22 20:24:30 +00004859 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00004860 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004861}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004862
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004863/// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4864/// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4865/// is acceptable.
4866static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4867 StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4868 // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4869 // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4870 // conversions are fine.
4871 switch (SCS.Second) {
4872 case ICK_Identity:
4873 case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4874 case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
Guy Benyei6959acd2013-02-07 16:05:33 +00004875 case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004876 return true;
4877
4878 case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
Richard Smith2bcb9842012-09-13 22:00:12 +00004879 // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4880 // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also an integral
4881 // conversion, so it's permitted in a converted constant expression.
4882 return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
4883 SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
4884
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004885 case ICK_Floating_Integral:
4886 case ICK_Complex_Real:
4887 return false;
4888
4889 case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
4890 case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
4891 case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
4892 case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4893 case ICK_Qualification:
4894 case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
4895 case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
4896 case ICK_Vector_Splat:
4897 case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
4898 case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
4899 case ICK_Pointer_Member:
4900 case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
4901 case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
4902 case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
4903 case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
4904 case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
4905 case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
4906 case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
4907 llvm_unreachable("unexpected second conversion kind");
4908
4909 case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
4910 break;
4911 }
4912
4913 llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
4914}
4915
4916/// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
4917/// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
4918/// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
4919ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
4920 llvm::APSInt &Value,
4921 CCEKind CCE) {
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00004922 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus11 && "converted constant expression outside C++11");
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004923 assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
4924
4925 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4926 return ExprError();
4927
4928 // C++11 [expr.const]p3 with proposed wording fixes:
4929 // A converted constant expression of type T is a core constant expression,
4930 // implicitly converted to a prvalue of type T, where the converted
4931 // expression is a literal constant expression and the implicit conversion
4932 // sequence contains only user-defined conversions, lvalue-to-rvalue
4933 // conversions, integral promotions, and integral conversions other than
4934 // narrowing conversions.
4935 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4936 TryImplicitConversion(From, T,
4937 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4938 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4939 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4940 /*CStyle=*/false,
4941 /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false);
4942 StandardConversionSequence *SCS = 0;
4943 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4944 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4945 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.Standard))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004946 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004947 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4948 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4949 SCS = &ICS.Standard;
4950 break;
4951 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4952 // We are converting from class type to an integral or enumeration type, so
4953 // the Before sequence must be trivial.
4954 if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(*this, ICS.UserDefined.After))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004955 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004956 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
4957 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4958 SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
4959 break;
4960 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4961 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4962 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00004963 return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004964 diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
4965 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
4966 return ExprError();
4967
4968 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4969 llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
4970 }
4971
4972 ExprResult Result = PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, AA_Converting);
4973 if (Result.isInvalid())
4974 return Result;
4975
4976 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
4977 APValue PreNarrowingValue;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004978 QualType PreNarrowingType;
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004979 switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
4980 PreNarrowingType)) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004981 case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
4982 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
4983 // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
4984 case NK_Not_Narrowing:
4985 break;
4986
4987 case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004988 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4989 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4990 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004991 << CCE << /*Constant*/1
Richard Smithf6028062012-03-23 23:55:39 +00004992 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004993 break;
4994
4995 case NK_Type_Narrowing:
Eli Friedman1ef28db2012-03-29 23:39:39 +00004996 Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4997 isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_cce_narrowing_sfinae :
4998 diag::err_cce_narrowing)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00004999 << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5000 break;
5001 }
5002
5003 // Check the expression is a constant expression.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005004 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005005 Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5006 Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5007
Douglas Gregor484f6fa2013-04-08 23:24:07 +00005008 if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, Context) || !Eval.Val.isInt()) {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005009 // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5010 // the AST.
5011 Result = ExprError();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005012 } else {
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005013 Value = Eval.Val.getInt();
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005014
5015 if (Notes.empty()) {
5016 // It's a constant expression.
5017 return Result;
5018 }
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005019 }
5020
5021 // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5022 if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5023 Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5024 Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5025 else {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00005026 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005027 << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5028 for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5029 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5030 }
Richard Smithf72fccf2012-01-30 22:27:01 +00005031 return Result;
Richard Smith8ef7b202012-01-18 23:55:52 +00005032}
5033
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005034/// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5035/// involves any pointer conversions, remove them. This may change
5036/// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5037static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5038 if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5039 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5040 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5041 SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5042 }
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005043}
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00005044
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005045/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5046/// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5047static ImplicitConversionSequence
5048TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5049 // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5050 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5051 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5052 = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5053 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5054 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5055 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5056 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5057 /*CStyle=*/false,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005058 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5059 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005060
5061 // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5062 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5063 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5064 case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5065 case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5066 break;
5067
5068 case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5069 dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5070 break;
5071
5072 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5073 dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5074 break;
5075 }
5076
5077 return ICS;
5078}
5079
5080/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5081/// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5082ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +00005083 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5084 return ExprError();
5085
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005086 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall0bcc9bc2011-09-09 06:11:02 +00005087 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5088 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005089 if (!ICS.isBad())
5090 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +00005091 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian79d3f042010-05-12 23:29:11 +00005092}
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00005093
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005094/// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5095/// type of a permitted flavor.
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005096bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5097 return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5098 : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005099}
5100
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005101static ExprResult
5102diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5103 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5104 QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5105
5106 if (Converter.Suppress)
5107 return ExprError();
5108
5109 Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5110 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5111 CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5112 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5113 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5114 Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5115 }
5116 return SemaRef.Owned(From);
5117}
5118
5119static bool
5120diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5121 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5122 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5123 UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5124 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5125 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5126 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5127 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5128
5129 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5130 // conversion; use it.
5131 QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5132 std::string TypeStr;
5133 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5134
5135 Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5136 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5137 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5138 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5139 SemaRef.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
5140 Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5141
5142 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5143 // explicit conversion function.
5144 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5145 return true;
5146
5147 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
5148 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5149 HadMultipleCandidates);
5150 if (Result.isInvalid())
5151 return true;
5152 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5153 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5154 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 0,
5155 Result.get()->getValueKind());
5156 }
5157 return false;
5158}
5159
5160static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5161 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5162 QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5163 DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5164 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5165 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5166 SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
5167
5168 QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5169 if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5170 if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5171 return true;
5172
5173 Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5174 << From->getSourceRange();
5175 }
5176
5177 ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5178 HadMultipleCandidates);
5179 if (Result.isInvalid())
5180 return true;
5181 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5182 From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5183 CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(), 0,
5184 Result.get()->getValueKind());
5185 return false;
5186}
5187
5188static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5189 Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5190 Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5191 if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5192 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5193 << From->getSourceRange();
5194
5195 return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5196}
5197
5198static void
5199collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5200 UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5201 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5202 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5203 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5204 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5205 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5206 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5207 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5208
5209 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5210 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5211 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5212 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5213 else
5214 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5215
5216 if (ConvTemplate)
5217 SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005218 ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5219 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005220 else
5221 SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005222 ToType, CandidateSet,
5223 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005224 }
5225}
5226
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005227/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5228/// by the given converter.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005229///
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005230/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5231/// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5232/// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5233/// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5234/// one target type.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005235///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005236/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5237/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005238///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +00005239/// \param From The expression we're converting from.
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005240///
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005241/// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005242///
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005243/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5244/// successful.
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005245ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5246 SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005247 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5248 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005249 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005250
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005251 // Process placeholders immediately.
5252 if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5253 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005254 if (result.isInvalid())
5255 return result;
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005256 From = result.take();
5257 }
5258
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005259 // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005260 QualType T = From->getType();
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005261 if (Converter.match(T))
Eli Friedmanceccab92012-01-26 00:26:18 +00005262 return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005263
5264 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5265
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005266 // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5267 // type.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005268 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005269 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005270 if (!Converter.Suppress)
5271 Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005272 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005273 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005274
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005275 // We must have a complete class type.
Douglas Gregorf502d8e2012-05-04 16:48:41 +00005276 struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005277 ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
Douglas Gregorab41fe92012-05-04 22:38:52 +00005278 Expr *From;
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005279
5280 TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5281 : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5282
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005283 virtual void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005284 Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005285 }
Richard Smith097e0a22013-05-21 19:05:48 +00005286 } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +00005287
5288 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005289 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005290
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005291 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005292 UnresolvedSet<4>
5293 ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005294 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00005295 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005296 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions =
5297 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005298
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005299 bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5300 (std::distance(Conversions.first, Conversions.second) > 1);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00005301
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005302 // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5303 QualType ToType;
5304 bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5305
5306 // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5307 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator I = Conversions.first,
5308 E = Conversions.second;
5309 I != E; ++I) {
5310 NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5311 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5312 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5313 if (ConvTemplate) {
5314 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y)
5315 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5316 else
5317 continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5318 } else
5319 Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5320
5321 assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) &&
5322 "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5323 "viable in C++1y");
5324
5325 QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5326 if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5327
5328 if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5329 // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5330 // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5331 if (!ConvTemplate)
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005332 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005333 } else {
5334 if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5335 if (ToType.isNull())
5336 ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5337 else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5338 (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5339 HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5340 }
5341 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005342 }
Richard Smithf39aec12012-02-04 07:07:42 +00005343 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005344 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005345
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005346 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y) {
5347 // C++1y [conv]p6:
5348 // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5349 // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5350 // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5351 // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
Larisse Voufo7acc5a62013-06-10 08:25:58 +00005352 // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5353 // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005354 // exactly one such T.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005355
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005356 // If no unique T is found:
5357 if (ToType.isNull()) {
5358 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5359 HadMultipleCandidates,
5360 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005361 return ExprError();
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005362 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005363 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005364
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005365 // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5366 if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5367 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5368 ViableConversions);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005369
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005370 // If one unique T is found:
5371 // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5372 // potentially viable conversions.
5373 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
5374 collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5375 CandidateSet);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005376
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005377 // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5378 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5379 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5380 case OR_Success: {
5381 // Apply this conversion.
5382 DeclAccessPair Found =
5383 DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5384 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5385 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5386 return ExprError();
5387 break;
5388 }
5389 case OR_Ambiguous:
5390 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5391 ViableConversions);
5392 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5393 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5394 HadMultipleCandidates,
5395 ExplicitConversions))
5396 return ExprError();
5397 // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5398 case OR_Deleted:
5399 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5400 break;
5401 }
5402 } else {
5403 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5404 case 0: {
5405 if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5406 HadMultipleCandidates,
5407 ExplicitConversions))
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005408 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005409
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005410 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5411 break;
Douglas Gregor6bc574d2010-06-30 00:20:43 +00005412 }
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005413 case 1: {
5414 // Apply this conversion.
5415 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5416 if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5417 HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5418 return ExprError();
5419 break;
5420 }
5421 default:
5422 return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5423 ViableConversions);
5424 }
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005425 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005426
Larisse Voufo50b60b32013-06-10 06:50:24 +00005427 return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
Douglas Gregorc30614b2010-06-29 23:17:37 +00005428}
5429
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005430/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005431/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
5432/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5433/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005434///
James Dennett699c9042012-06-15 07:13:21 +00005435/// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00005436/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5437/// code completion.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005438void
5439Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005440 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005441 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor225c41e2008-11-03 19:09:14 +00005442 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redle2b68332009-04-12 17:16:29 +00005443 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005444 bool PartialOverloading,
5445 bool AllowExplicit) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005446 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005447 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005448 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005449 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi00995302011-01-27 07:09:49 +00005450 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005451
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005452 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005453 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5454 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5455 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5456 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5457 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005458 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5459 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5460 // is irrelevant.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005461 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005462 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005463 Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005464 return;
5465 }
5466 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5467 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005468 }
5469
Douglas Gregorfd476482009-11-13 23:59:09 +00005470 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005471 return;
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005472
Richard Smith743cbb92013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005473 // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5474 // A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5475 // overload resolution.
5476 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5477 if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5478 Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5479 return;
5480
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005481 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005482 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005483
Richard Smith743cbb92013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005484 if (Constructor) {
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005485 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5486 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5487 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
5488 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005489 if (Args.size() == 1 &&
Douglas Gregor6493cc52010-11-08 17:16:59 +00005490 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor12116062010-02-21 18:30:38 +00005491 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5492 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregor66724ea2009-11-14 01:20:54 +00005493 return;
5494 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005495
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005496 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005497 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005498 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005499 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005500 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005501 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005502 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005503 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005504
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005505 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5506
5507 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5508 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5509 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005510 if ((Args.size() + (PartialOverloading && Args.size())) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor5bd1a112009-09-23 14:56:09 +00005511 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005512 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005513 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005514 return;
5515 }
5516
5517 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5518 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5519 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5520 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5521 // exactly m parameters.
5522 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005523 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005524 // Not enough arguments.
5525 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005526 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005527 return;
5528 }
5529
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005530 // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005531 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00005532 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5533 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5534 Candidate.Viable = false;
5535 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5536 return;
5537 }
5538
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005539 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5540 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005541 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005542 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5543 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5544 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5545 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5546 // parameter of F.
5547 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005548 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005549 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005550 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005551 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5552 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005553 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
Douglas Gregored878af2012-02-24 23:56:31 +00005554 AllowExplicit);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005555 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5556 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005557 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005558 break;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005559 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005560 } else {
5561 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5562 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5563 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005564 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00005565 }
5566 }
5567}
5568
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005569/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
Nick Lewycky199e3702013-09-22 10:06:01 +00005570/// the overload candidate set.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005571void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005572 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005573 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005574 bool SuppressUserConversions,
5575 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00005576 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005577 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5578 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005579 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005580 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005581 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005582 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005583 Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5584 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005585 else
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005586 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005587 SuppressUserConversions);
5588 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005589 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005590 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5591 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005592 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005593 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005594 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005595 Args[0]->getType(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005596 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5597 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005598 else
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005599 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +00005600 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005601 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005602 }
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00005603 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00005604}
5605
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005606/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
5607/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005608void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005609 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005610 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005611 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005612 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005613 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005614 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005615 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005616
5617 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
5618 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005619
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005620 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
5621 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5622 "Expected a member function template");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005623 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
5624 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005625 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005626 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005627 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005628 } else {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005629 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005630 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00005631 Args,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005632 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00005633 }
5634}
5635
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005636/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
5637/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
5638/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
5639/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
5640/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
5641/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005642/// operators.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005643void
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005644Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall86820f52010-01-26 01:37:31 +00005645 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005646 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005647 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005648 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005649 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005650 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005651 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005652 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00005653 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
5654 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005655
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005656 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
5657 return;
5658
Richard Smith743cbb92013-11-04 01:48:18 +00005659 // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
5660 // A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
5661 // ignored by overload resolution.
5662 if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
5663 Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
5664 return;
5665
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005666 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005667 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005668
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005669 // Add this candidate
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005670 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005671 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005672 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005673 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005674 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005675 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005676
5677 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
5678
5679 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5680 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5681 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005682 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005683 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005684 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005685 return;
5686 }
5687
5688 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5689 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5690 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5691 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5692 // exactly m parameters.
5693 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005694 if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005695 // Not enough arguments.
5696 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005697 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005698 return;
5699 }
5700
5701 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005702
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005703 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005704 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
5705 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
5706 else {
5707 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
5708 // parameter.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005709 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005710 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
5711 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005712 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005713 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005714 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005715 return;
5716 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005717 }
5718
5719 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5720 // arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005721 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005722 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5723 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5724 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5725 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5726 // parameter of F.
5727 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005728 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00005729 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005730 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00005731 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5732 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00005733 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005734 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005735 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005736 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005737 break;
5738 }
5739 } else {
5740 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5741 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5742 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005743 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00005744 }
5745 }
5746}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005747
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005748/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
5749/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
5750/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005751void
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005752Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005753 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005754 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005755 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005756 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005757 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005758 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005759 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005760 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005761 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
5762 return;
5763
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005764 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005765 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005766 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005767 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005768 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5769 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5770 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5771 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5772 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005773 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005774 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5775 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005776 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5777 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005778 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005779 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5780 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
5781 Candidate.Viable = false;
5782 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
5783 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5784 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005785 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005786 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005787 Info);
5788 return;
5789 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005790
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005791 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5792 // deduction as a candidate.
5793 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005794 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005795 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005796 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005797 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
5798 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +00005799}
5800
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005801/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
5802/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
5803/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005804void
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005805Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005806 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00005807 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00005808 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005809 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005810 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005811 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
5812 return;
5813
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005814 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005815 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005816 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005817 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005818 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
5819 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
5820 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
5821 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
5822 // functions.
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00005823 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005824 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
5825 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005826 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
5827 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005828 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005829 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005830 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
5831 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005832 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00005833 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5834 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005835 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005836 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00005837 Info);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005838 return;
5839 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005840
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005841 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
5842 // deduction as a candidate.
5843 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00005844 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor7ec77522010-04-16 17:33:27 +00005845 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00005846}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005847
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005848/// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
5849/// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
5850/// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
5851///
5852/// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
5853///
5854/// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
5855///
5856/// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
5857/// Objective-C pointer to another.
5858///
5859/// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
5860static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
5861 QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
5862 bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
5863 QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
5864
5865 // Easy case: the types are the same.
5866 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
5867 return true;
5868
5869 // Allow qualification conversions.
5870 bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
5871 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
5872 ObjCLifetimeConversion))
5873 return true;
5874
5875 // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
5876 // we're done.
5877 if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
5878 return false;
5879
5880 // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
5881 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
5882 QualType ConvertedType;
5883 return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
5884 IncompatibleObjC);
5885}
5886
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005887/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005888/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005889/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005890/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005891/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
5892/// conversion function produces).
5893void
5894Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005895 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00005896 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005897 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005898 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5899 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00005900 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5901 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005902 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00005903 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
5904 return;
5905
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00005906 // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
5907 // deduction now.
5908 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
5909 if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
5910 return;
5911 ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5912 }
5913
Richard Smithb390e492013-09-21 21:55:46 +00005914 // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
5915 // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
5916 // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00005917 if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
5918 !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
5919 AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
Richard Smithb390e492013-09-21 21:55:46 +00005920 return;
5921
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005922 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00005923 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00005924
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005925 // Add this candidate
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00005926 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00005927 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005928 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00005929 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00005930 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005931 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor3fbaf3e2010-04-17 22:01:05 +00005932 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregorad323a82010-01-27 03:51:04 +00005933 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005934 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00005935 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005936
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005937 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005938 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
5939 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregorbca39322010-08-19 15:37:02 +00005940 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005941 //
5942 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
5943 // object parameter.
5944 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
5945 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
5946 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
5947 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
5948 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005949
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005950 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005951 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
5952 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005953 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005954
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00005955 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005956 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00005957 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005958 return;
5959 }
Douglas Gregorc774b2f2010-08-19 15:57:50 +00005960
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005961 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005962 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
5963 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
5964 QualType FromCanon
5965 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
5966 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
5967 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
5968 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00005969 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian3759a032009-10-19 19:18:20 +00005970 return;
5971 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005972
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00005973 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
5974 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
5975 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
5976 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
5977 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
5978 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
5979 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
5980 // well-formed.
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +00005981 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005982 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00005983 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
5984 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005985 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00005986 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005987
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005988 QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
5989 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
Douglas Gregor7d14d382010-11-13 19:36:57 +00005990 Candidate.Viable = false;
5991 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
5992 return;
5993 }
5994
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00005995 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00005996
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005997 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00005998 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
5999 // allocator).
Richard Smith87c1f1f2011-07-13 22:53:21 +00006000 QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Dmitri Gribenko62ed8892013-05-05 20:40:26 +00006001 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregor0a0d1ac2009-11-17 21:16:22 +00006002 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006003 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006004 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006005 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006006 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6007 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006008
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006009 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006010 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6011 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006012
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006013 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6014 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006015 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006016 // shall have exact match rank.
6017 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6018 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6019 Candidate.Viable = false;
6020 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
6021 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006022
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006023 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6024 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6025 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6026 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6027 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006028 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregor2ad746a2011-01-21 05:18:22 +00006029 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6030 Candidate.Viable = false;
6031 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6032 }
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006033 break;
6034
6035 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6036 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006037 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006038 break;
6039
6040 default:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006041 llvm_unreachable(
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006042 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6043 }
6044}
6045
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006046/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
6047/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
6048/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
6049/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
6050/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006051void
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006052Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006053 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006054 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006055 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006056 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6057 bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006058 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6059 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
6060
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006061 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6062 return;
6063
Craig Topper93e45992012-09-19 02:26:47 +00006064 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006065 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
6066 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006067 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006068 Specialization, Info)) {
Benjamin Kramer0e6a16f2012-01-14 16:31:55 +00006069 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006070 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6071 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6072 Candidate.Viable = false;
6073 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6074 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6075 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006076 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006077 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregorff5adac2010-05-08 20:18:54 +00006078 Info);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006079 return;
6080 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006081
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006082 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6083 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6084 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006085 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor1ce55092013-11-07 22:34:54 +00006086 CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006087}
6088
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006089/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6090/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6091/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6092/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6093/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6094void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006095 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +00006096 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006097 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006098 Expr *Object,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00006099 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006100 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor3f396022009-09-28 04:47:19 +00006101 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6102 return;
6103
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006104 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006105 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006106
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006107 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006108 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006109 Candidate.Function = 0;
6110 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6111 Candidate.Viable = true;
6112 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006113 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006114 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006115
6116 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6117 // object parameter.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006118 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006119 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006120 Object->Classify(Context),
6121 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006122 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006123 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006124 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006125 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006126 return;
6127 }
6128
6129 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6130 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6131 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006132 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006133 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian966256a2009-11-06 00:23:08 +00006134 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +00006135 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006136 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
John McCallca82a822011-09-21 08:36:56 +00006137 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006138 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006139 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6140 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6141
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006142 // Find the
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006143 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
6144
6145 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6146 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6147 // list (8.3.5).
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006148 if (Args.size() > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006149 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006150 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006151 return;
6152 }
6153
6154 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6155 // we have enough arguments.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00006156 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006157 // Not enough arguments.
6158 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006159 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006160 return;
6161 }
6162
6163 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6164 // arguments.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006165 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006166 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
6167 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6168 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6169 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6170 // parameter of F.
6171 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006172 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006173 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006174 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006175 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6176 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006177 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006178 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006179 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006180 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006181 break;
6182 }
6183 } else {
6184 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6185 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6186 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006187 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006188 }
6189 }
6190}
6191
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006192/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6193/// member functions.
6194///
6195/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6196/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6197/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6198/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6199/// [over.match.oper]).
6200void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6201 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006202 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006203 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6204 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006205 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6206
6207 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6208 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6209 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6210 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6211 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6212 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6213 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6214 // constructed as follows:
6215 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006216
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006217 // -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6218 // defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6219 // qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6220 // the set of member candidates is empty.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006221 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Richard Smithe410be92013-04-20 12:41:22 +00006222 // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6223 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6224 // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6225 if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006226 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006227
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +00006228 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6229 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6230 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6231
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006232 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor8a5ae242009-08-27 23:35:55 +00006233 OperEnd = Operators.end();
6234 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006235 ++Oper)
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006236 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
Rafael Espindola548107e2013-04-29 19:29:25 +00006237 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006238 Args.slice(1),
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006239 CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +00006240 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006241 }
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006242}
6243
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006244/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6245/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6246/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006247/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6248/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006249/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6250/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6251/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006252void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006253 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006254 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006255 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6256 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006257 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +00006258 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor7edfb692009-11-23 12:27:39 +00006259
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006260 // Add this candidate
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006261 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006262 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006263 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregorc9467cf2008-12-12 02:00:36 +00006264 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006265 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006266 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006267 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006268 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6269
6270 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6271 // arguments.
6272 Candidate.Viable = true;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006273 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6274 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006275 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6276 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6277 // left operand are restricted as follows:
6278 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6279 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6280 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006281 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregor88b4bf22009-01-13 00:52:54 +00006282 //
6283 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6284 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6285 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6286 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006287 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006288 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006289 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006290 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6291 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006292 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006293 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00006294 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlssond28b4282009-08-27 17:18:13 +00006295 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006296 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6297 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006298 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006299 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006300 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006301 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006302 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor96176b32008-11-18 23:14:02 +00006303 break;
6304 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006305 }
6306}
6307
Craig Topperfe09f3f2013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006308namespace {
6309
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006310/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6311/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6312/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6313/// enumeration types.
6314class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
6315 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006316 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006317
6318 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6319 /// built-in candidates.
6320 TypeSet PointerTypes;
6321
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006322 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6323 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6324 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6325
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006326 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6327 /// used in the built-in candidates.
6328 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6329
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006330 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006331 /// candidates.
6332 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006333
6334 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6335 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6336
6337 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6338 /// were present in the candidate set.
6339 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6340
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006341 /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6342 /// candidate set.
6343 bool HasNullPtrType;
6344
Douglas Gregor5842ba92009-08-24 15:23:48 +00006345 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6346 /// candidate type set.
6347 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006348
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006349 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6350 ASTContext &Context;
6351
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006352 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6353 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006354 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006355
6356public:
6357 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006358 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006359
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006360 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006361 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6362 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006363 HasNullPtrType(false),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006364 SemaRef(SemaRef),
6365 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006366
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006367 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006368 SourceLocation Loc,
6369 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006370 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6371 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006372
6373 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6374 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6375
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006376 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006377 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6378
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006379 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6380 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6381
6382 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6383 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6384
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006385 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6386 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6387
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006388 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006389 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006390
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006391 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6392 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006393
6394 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6395 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006396 bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006397};
6398
Craig Topperfe09f3f2013-07-01 06:29:40 +00006399} // end anonymous namespace
6400
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006401/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006402/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6403/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6404/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6405/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6406/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6407/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006408///
6409/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006410bool
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006411BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6412 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006413
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006414 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006415 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006416 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006417
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006418 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006419 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006420 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006421 if (!PointerTy) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006422 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6423 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6424 buildObjCPtr = true;
6425 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006426 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006427 }
6428
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006429 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6430 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6431 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6432 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6433 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6434 return true;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006435
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006436 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006437 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6438 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006439
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006440 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6441 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6442 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006443 // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006444 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006445
6446 // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6447 // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6448 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6449 (!hasRestrict ||
6450 (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6451 continue;
6452
6453 // Build qualified pointee type.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006454 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006455
6456 // Build qualified pointer type.
6457 QualType QPointerTy;
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006458 if (!buildObjCPtr)
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006459 QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
Fariborz Jahanian957b4df2010-08-21 17:11:09 +00006460 else
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006461 QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6462
6463 // Insert qualified pointer type.
6464 PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006465 }
6466
6467 return true;
6468}
6469
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006470/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6471/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6472/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6473/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6474/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6475/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6476/// false otherwise.
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006477///
6478/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006479bool
6480BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6481 QualType Ty) {
6482 // Insert this type.
6483 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
6484 return false;
6485
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006486 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6487 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006488
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006489 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redla9efada2009-11-18 20:39:26 +00006490 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6491 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6492 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6493 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6494 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6495 return true;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006496 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6497
6498 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6499 // qualifiers.
6500 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6501 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6502 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006503
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006504 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006505 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6506 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006507 }
6508
6509 return true;
6510}
6511
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006512/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6513/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006514/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6515/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006516/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6517/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6518/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6519/// type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006520void
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006521BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregor573d9c32009-10-21 23:19:44 +00006522 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor09f41cf2009-01-14 15:45:31 +00006523 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006524 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6525 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006526 // Only deal with canonical types.
6527 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6528
6529 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6530 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006531 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006532 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6533
John McCall3b657512011-01-19 10:06:00 +00006534 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6535 if (Ty->isArrayType())
6536 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6537
6538 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00006539 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006540
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006541 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6542 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6543 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6544
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006545 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6546 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6547 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6548
Fariborz Jahanian2e2acec2010-08-21 00:10:36 +00006549 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6550 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6551 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006552 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6553 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006554 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006555 return;
Sebastian Redl78eb8742009-04-19 21:53:20 +00006556 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6557 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6558 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6559 return;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006560 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006561 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnere37b94c2009-03-29 00:04:01 +00006562 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006563 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006564 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
6565 // extension.
6566 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006567 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00006568 } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
6569 HasNullPtrType = true;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006570 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
6571 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
6572 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
6573 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006574
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006575 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006576 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6577 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6578 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6579 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6580 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006581 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6582 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6583 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006584
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006585 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
6586 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
6587 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
6588 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006589
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006590 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6591 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
6592 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
6593 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006594 }
6595 }
6596 }
6597}
6598
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006599/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
6600/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
6601/// given type to the candidate set.
6602static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
6603 QualType T,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006604 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006605 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
6606 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006607
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006608 // T& operator=(T&, T)
6609 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6610 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006611 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006612 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006613
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006614 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
6615 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00006616 ParamTypes[0]
6617 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006618 ParamTypes[1] = T;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006619 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006620 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006621 }
6622}
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006623
Sebastian Redl9994a342009-10-25 17:03:50 +00006624/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
6625/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006626static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
6627 Qualifiers VRQuals;
6628 const RecordType *TyRec;
6629 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
6630 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregorb86cf0c2010-04-25 00:55:24 +00006631 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006632 else
6633 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
6634 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanian1cad6022009-10-16 22:08:05 +00006635 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006636 VRQuals.addVolatile();
6637 VRQuals.addRestrict();
6638 return VRQuals;
6639 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006640
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006641 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall86ff3082010-02-04 22:26:26 +00006642 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
6643 return VRQuals;
6644
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006645 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
6646 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator>
6647 Conversions = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006648
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +00006649 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
6650 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall32daa422010-03-31 01:36:47 +00006651 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
6652 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
6653 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
6654 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006655 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
6656 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6657 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6658 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
6659 // as see them.
6660 bool done = false;
6661 while (!done) {
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006662 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
6663 VRQuals.addRestrict();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006664 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6665 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006666 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006667 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
6668 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
6669 else
6670 done = true;
6671 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
6672 VRQuals.addVolatile();
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00006673 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
6674 return VRQuals;
6675 }
6676 }
6677 }
6678 return VRQuals;
6679}
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006680
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006681namespace {
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006682
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006683/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
6684/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
6685/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
6686/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
6687class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006688 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
6689 Sema &S;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006690 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006691 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006692 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006693 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006694 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006695
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006696 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
6697 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006698 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
6699 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006700 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006701 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006702 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006703 LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006704 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006705 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
6706 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006707
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006708 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
6709 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
6710 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
6711 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
6712 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
6713 // Start of promoted types.
6714 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
6715 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
6716 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall00071ec2010-11-13 05:51:15 +00006717
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006718 // Start of integral types.
6719 &ASTContext::IntTy,
6720 &ASTContext::LongTy,
6721 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006722 &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006723 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
6724 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
6725 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006726 &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006727 // End of promoted types.
6728
6729 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
6730 &ASTContext::CharTy,
6731 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
6732 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
6733 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
6734 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
6735 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
6736 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
6737 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
6738 // End of integral types.
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006739 // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006740 };
6741 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
6742 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006743
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006744 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
6745 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
6746 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
6747 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
6748 // The rules are basically:
6749 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
6750 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
6751 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
6752 // - use the larger type
6753 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
6754 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
6755 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
6756 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
6757 // better not to make any assumptions).
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006758 // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006759 enum PromotedType {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006760 Dep=-1,
6761 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006762 };
Nuno Lopes79e244f2012-04-21 14:45:25 +00006763 static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006764 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006765/* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
6766/* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
6767/*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
6768/* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6769/* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, S128, Dep, UL, ULL, U128 },
6770/* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, S128, Dep, Dep, ULL, U128 },
6771/*S128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
6772/* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, S128, UI, UL, ULL, U128 },
6773/* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, S128, UL, UL, ULL, U128 },
6774/* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, S128, ULL, ULL, ULL, U128 },
6775/*U128*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006776 };
6777
6778 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6779 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
6780 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
6781
6782 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006783 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006784
6785 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
6786 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006787 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
6788 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00006789 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
6790 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
6791
6792 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
6793 if (LW > RW) return LT;
6794 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
6795
6796 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
6797 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
6798 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
6799 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
6800 }
6801
Chandler Carruth3c69dc42010-12-12 09:22:45 +00006802 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
6803 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006804 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006805 bool HasVolatile,
6806 bool HasRestrict) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006807 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6808 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
6809 S.Context.IntTy
6810 };
6811
6812 // Non-volatile version.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006813 if (Args.size() == 1)
6814 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006815 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006816 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006817
6818 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
6819 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
6820 if (HasVolatile) {
6821 ParamTypes[0] =
6822 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6823 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006824 if (Args.size() == 1)
6825 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006826 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006827 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006828 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006829
6830 // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
6831 // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
6832 if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
6833 !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
6834 ParamTypes[0]
6835 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6836 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006837 if (Args.size() == 1)
6838 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006839 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006840 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006841
6842 if (HasVolatile) {
6843 ParamTypes[0]
6844 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
6845 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
6846 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
6847 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006848 if (Args.size() == 1)
6849 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006850 else
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006851 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006852 }
6853 }
6854
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006855 }
6856
6857public:
6858 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006859 Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006860 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006861 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006862 SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006863 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006864 : S(S), Args(Args),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006865 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006866 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
6867 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006868 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
6869 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
6870 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006871 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006872 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006873 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006874 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006875 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006876 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
6877 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006878 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006879 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
Richard Smith3c2fcf82012-06-10 08:00:26 +00006880 == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006881 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
6882 }
6883
6884 // C++ [over.built]p3:
6885 //
6886 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
6887 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
6888 // functions of the form
6889 //
6890 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
6891 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
6892 //
6893 // C++ [over.built]p4:
6894 //
6895 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
6896 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
6897 // candidate operator functions of the form
6898 //
6899 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
6900 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
6901 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006902 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6903 return;
6904
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006905 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
6906 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
6907 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006908 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006909 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
6910 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006911 }
6912 }
6913
6914 // C++ [over.built]p5:
6915 //
6916 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6917 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
6918 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6919 //
6920 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
6921 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
6922 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
6923 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
6924 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
6925 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6926 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6927 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6928 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6929 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006930 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006931 continue;
6932
6933 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00006934 (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6935 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
6936 (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
6937 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006938 }
6939 }
6940
6941 // C++ [over.built]p6:
6942 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
6943 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
6944 //
6945 // T& operator*(T*);
6946 //
6947 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006948 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006949 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006950 // T& operator*(T*);
6951 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
6952 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6953 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6954 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6955 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6956 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
6957 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00006958 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6959 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006960
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +00006961 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
6962 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
6963 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006964
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006965 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006966 &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006967 }
6968 }
6969
6970 // C++ [over.built]p9:
6971 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
6972 // operator functions of the form
6973 //
6974 // T operator+(T);
6975 // T operator-(T);
6976 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00006977 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6978 return;
6979
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006980 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6981 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00006982 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006983 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006984 }
6985
6986 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
6987 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6988 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6989 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6990 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
6991 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00006992 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006993 }
6994 }
6995
6996 // C++ [over.built]p8:
6997 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
6998 // the form
6999 //
7000 // T* operator+(T*);
7001 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7002 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7003 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7004 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7005 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7006 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007007 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007008 }
7009 }
7010
7011 // C++ [over.built]p10:
7012 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7013 // operator functions of the form
7014 //
7015 // T operator~(T);
7016 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007017 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7018 return;
7019
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007020 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7021 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007022 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007023 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007024 }
7025
7026 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7027 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7028 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7029 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7030 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7031 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007032 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007033 }
7034 }
7035
7036 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7037 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
7038 // functions of the form
7039 //
7040 // bool operator==(T,T);
7041 // bool operator!=(T,T);
7042 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
7043 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7044 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7045
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007046 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007047 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7048 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7049 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7050 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7051 ++MemPtr) {
7052 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7053 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7054 continue;
7055
7056 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007057 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007058 }
7059 }
7060 }
7061
7062 // C++ [over.built]p15:
7063 //
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007064 // For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
7065 // std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007066 //
7067 // bool operator<(T, T);
7068 // bool operator>(T, T);
7069 // bool operator<=(T, T);
7070 // bool operator>=(T, T);
7071 // bool operator==(T, T);
7072 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007073 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007074 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7075 // [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7076 // functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7077 // do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7078 // candidate.
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007079 //
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007080 // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7081 // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7082 // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7083 // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007084 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7085 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7086 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7087 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7088
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007089 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007090 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7091 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7092 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7093 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7094 C != CEnd; ++C) {
7095 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7096 continue;
7097
Eli Friedman97c67392012-09-18 21:52:24 +00007098 if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7099 continue;
7100
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007101 QualType FirstParamType =
7102 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7103 QualType SecondParamType =
7104 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7105
7106 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7107 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7108 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7109 continue;
7110
7111 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7112 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7113 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7114 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7115 }
7116 }
7117 }
7118
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007119 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7120 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7121
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007122 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007123 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7124 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7125 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7126 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7127 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7128 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7129 continue;
7130
7131 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007132 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007133 }
7134 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7135 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7136 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7137 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7138 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7139
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007140 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7141 // candidate exists.
7142 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
7143 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7144 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007145 continue;
7146
7147 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007148 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007149 }
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007150
7151 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7152 CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7153 if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007154 !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007155 NullPtrTy))) {
7156 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007157 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
Douglas Gregor84ee2ee2011-05-21 23:15:46 +00007158 CandidateSet);
7159 }
7160 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007161 }
7162 }
7163
7164 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7165 //
7166 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7167 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7168 //
7169 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7170 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
7171 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7172 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7173 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
7174 //
7175 // C++ [over.built]p14:
7176 //
7177 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7178 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7179 //
7180 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7181 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7182 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7183 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7184
7185 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7186 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
7187 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7188 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7189 };
7190 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7191 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7192 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7193 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007194 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7195 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7196 continue;
7197
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007198 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7199 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7200 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7201 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007202 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007203 }
7204 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7205 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7206 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7207 continue;
7208
7209 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7210 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007211 Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007212 }
7213 }
7214 }
7215 }
7216
7217 // C++ [over.built]p12:
7218 //
7219 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7220 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7221 //
7222 // LR operator*(L, R);
7223 // LR operator/(L, R);
7224 // LR operator+(L, R);
7225 // LR operator-(L, R);
7226 // bool operator<(L, R);
7227 // bool operator>(L, R);
7228 // bool operator<=(L, R);
7229 // bool operator>=(L, R);
7230 // bool operator==(L, R);
7231 // bool operator!=(L, R);
7232 //
7233 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7234 // between types L and R.
7235 //
7236 // C++ [over.built]p24:
7237 //
7238 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7239 // candidate operator functions of the form
7240 //
7241 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
7242 //
7243 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7244 // between types L and R.
7245 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7246 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007247 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7248 return;
7249
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007250 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7251 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7252 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7253 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007254 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7255 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007256 QualType Result =
7257 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007258 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007259 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007260 }
7261 }
7262
7263 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7264 // conditional operator for vector types.
7265 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7266 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7267 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7268 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7269 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7270 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7271 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7272 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7273 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7274 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7275 if (!isComparison) {
7276 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7277 Result = *Vec1;
7278 else
7279 Result = *Vec2;
7280 }
7281
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007282 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007283 }
7284 }
7285 }
7286
7287 // C++ [over.built]p17:
7288 //
7289 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7290 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7291 //
7292 // LR operator%(L, R);
7293 // LR operator&(L, R);
7294 // LR operator^(L, R);
7295 // LR operator|(L, R);
7296 // L operator<<(L, R);
7297 // L operator>>(L, R);
7298 //
7299 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7300 // between types L and R.
7301 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007302 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7303 return;
7304
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007305 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7306 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7307 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7308 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007309 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7310 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007311 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7312 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth38ca8d12010-12-12 09:59:53 +00007313 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007314 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007315 }
7316 }
7317 }
7318
7319 // C++ [over.built]p20:
7320 //
7321 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7322 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7323 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7324 //
7325 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
7326 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7327 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7328 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7329
7330 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7331 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7332 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7333 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7334 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7335 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7336 continue;
7337
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007338 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007339 }
7340
7341 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7342 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7343 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7344 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7345 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7346 continue;
7347
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007348 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007349 }
7350 }
7351 }
7352
7353 // C++ [over.built]p19:
7354 //
7355 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7356 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7357 // of the form
7358 //
7359 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7360 //
7361 // C++ [over.built]p21:
7362 //
7363 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7364 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7365 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7366 //
7367 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7368 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7369 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7370 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7371 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7372
7373 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7374 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7375 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7376 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7377 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7378 if (isEqualOp)
7379 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007380 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7381 continue;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007382
7383 // non-volatile version
7384 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7385 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7386 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7387 };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007388 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007389 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7390
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007391 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7392 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7393 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007394 // volatile version
7395 ParamTypes[0] =
7396 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007397 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007398 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7399 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007400
7401 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7402 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7403 // restrict version
7404 ParamTypes[0]
7405 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007406 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007407 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7408
7409 if (NeedVolatile) {
7410 // volatile restrict version
7411 ParamTypes[0]
7412 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7413 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7414 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7415 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007416 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007417 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7418 }
7419 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007420 }
7421
7422 if (isEqualOp) {
7423 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7424 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7425 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7426 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7427 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7428 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7429 continue;
7430
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007431 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7432 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7433 *Ptr,
7434 };
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007435
7436 // non-volatile version
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007437 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007438 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7439
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007440 bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7441 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7442 if (NeedVolatile) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007443 // volatile version
7444 ParamTypes[0] =
7445 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007446 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7447 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007448 }
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007449
7450 if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7451 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7452 // restrict version
7453 ParamTypes[0]
7454 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007455 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7456 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007457
7458 if (NeedVolatile) {
7459 // volatile restrict version
7460 ParamTypes[0]
7461 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7462 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7463 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7464 Qualifiers::Restrict)));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007465 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7466 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregorb1c6f5f2012-06-04 00:15:09 +00007467 }
7468 }
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007469 }
7470 }
7471 }
7472
7473 // C++ [over.built]p18:
7474 //
7475 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7476 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7477 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7478 // the form
7479 //
7480 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
7481 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7482 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7483 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7484 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7485 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007486 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7487 return;
7488
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007489 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7490 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7491 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7492 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007493 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007494
7495 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7496 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007497 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007498 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007499 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7500
7501 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7502 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7503 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007504 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007505 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007506 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007507 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7508 }
7509 }
7510 }
7511
7512 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7513 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7514 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7515 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7516 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7517 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7518 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7519 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7520 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7521 QualType ParamTypes[2];
7522 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7523 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7524 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007525 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007526 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7527
7528 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7529 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7530 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7531 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007532 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007533 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7534 }
7535 }
7536 }
7537 }
7538
7539 // C++ [over.built]p22:
7540 //
7541 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7542 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7543 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7544 //
7545 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7546 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7547 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7548 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7549 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7550 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7551 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007552 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7553 return;
7554
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007555 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7556 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7557 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7558 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007559 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007560
7561 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7562 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007563 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007564 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007565 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7566 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruth6d695582010-12-12 10:35:00 +00007567 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007568 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7569 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007570 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007571 }
7572 }
7573 }
7574 }
7575
7576 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
7577 //
7578 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
7579 //
7580 // bool operator!(bool);
7581 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
7582 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
7583 void addExclaimOverload() {
7584 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007585 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007586 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7587 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
7588 }
7589 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
7590 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007591 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007592 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
7593 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
7594 }
7595
7596 // C++ [over.built]p13:
7597 //
7598 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
7599 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
7600 //
7601 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7602 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
7603 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
7604 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
7605 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
7606 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
7607 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7608 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7609 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7610 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7611 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
7612 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007613 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7614 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007615
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007616 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7617
7618 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007619 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007620 }
7621
7622 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7623 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7624 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7625 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7626 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
7627 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor2fdc5e82011-01-05 00:13:17 +00007628 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
7629 continue;
7630
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007631 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
7632
7633 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007634 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007635 }
7636 }
7637
7638 // C++ [over.built]p11:
7639 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
7640 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
7641 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
7642 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7643 //
7644 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
7645 //
7646 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
7647 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
7648 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7649 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7650 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7651 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7652 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
7653 QualType C1;
7654 QualifierCollector Q1;
7655 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
7656 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
7657 continue;
7658 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
7659 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
7660 // volatile/restrict type.
7661 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
7662 continue;
7663 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
7664 continue;
7665 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7666 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
7667 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
7668 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7669 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
7670 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
7671 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
7672 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
7673 break;
7674 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
7675 // build CV12 T&
7676 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
7677 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
7678 T.isVolatileQualified())
7679 continue;
7680 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
7681 T.isRestrictQualified())
7682 continue;
7683 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
7684 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007685 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007686 }
7687 }
7688 }
7689
7690 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
7691 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
7692 // therefore added as binary.
7693 //
7694 // C++ [over.built]p25:
7695 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
7696 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7697 //
7698 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
7699 //
7700 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
7701 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7702 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7703
7704 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7705 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7706 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7707 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7708 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7709 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
7710 continue;
7711
7712 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007713 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007714 }
7715
7716 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7717 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7718 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7719 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7720 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
7721 continue;
7722
7723 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007724 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007725 }
7726
Richard Smith80ad52f2013-01-02 11:42:31 +00007727 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007728 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7729 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7730 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7731 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7732 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
7733 continue;
7734
7735 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
7736 continue;
7737
7738 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007739 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007740 }
7741 }
7742 }
7743 }
7744};
7745
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007746} // end anonymous namespace
7747
7748/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
7749/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
7750/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
7751/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
7752/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
Robert Wilhelm834c0582013-08-09 18:02:13 +00007753void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7754 SourceLocation OpLoc,
7755 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7756 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007757 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
7758 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007759 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
7760 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahaniana9cca892009-10-15 17:14:05 +00007761 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7762 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007763 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
Fariborz Jahanian8621d012009-10-19 21:30:45 +00007764 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007765
7766 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
7767 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007768 SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007769 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007770 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
7771 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
7772 OpLoc,
7773 true,
7774 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
7775 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
7776 Op == OO_PipePipe),
7777 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007778 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
7779 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
7780 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
7781 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
7782 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorfec56e72010-11-03 17:00:07 +00007783 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007784
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007785 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
7786 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007787 //
7788 // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
7789 // 'bool' overloads.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007790 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
Douglas Gregor25aaff92011-10-10 14:05:31 +00007791 !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007792 return;
7793
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007794 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007795 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007796 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth6a577462010-12-13 01:44:01 +00007797 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007798 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
7799
7800 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007801 switch (Op) {
7802 case OO_None:
7803 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007804 llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007805
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007806 case OO_New:
7807 case OO_Delete:
7808 case OO_Array_New:
7809 case OO_Array_Delete:
7810 case OO_Call:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007811 llvm_unreachable(
7812 "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007813
7814 case OO_Comma:
7815 case OO_Arrow:
7816 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7817 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7818 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007819 break;
7820
7821 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007822 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007823 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth32fe0d02010-12-12 08:41:34 +00007824 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007825
7826 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007827 if (Args.size() == 1) {
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007828 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007829 } else {
7830 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
7831 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7832 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007833 break;
7834
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007835 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007836 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007837 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
7838 else
7839 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7840 break;
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007841
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007842 case OO_Slash:
7843 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007844 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007845
7846 case OO_PlusPlus:
7847 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007848 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7849 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007850 break;
7851
Douglas Gregor19b7b152009-08-24 13:43:27 +00007852 case OO_EqualEqual:
7853 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007854 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007855 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruthc1409462010-12-12 08:45:02 +00007856
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007857 case OO_Less:
7858 case OO_Greater:
7859 case OO_LessEqual:
7860 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruth7b80b4b2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00007861 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruthdaf55d32010-12-12 08:32:28 +00007862 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
7863 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007864
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007865 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007866 case OO_Caret:
7867 case OO_Pipe:
7868 case OO_LessLess:
7869 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007870 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007871 break;
7872
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007873 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +00007874 if (Args.size() == 1)
Chandler Carruthabb71842010-12-12 08:51:33 +00007875 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7876 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
7877 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
7878 break;
7879
7880 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
7881 break;
7882
7883 case OO_Tilde:
7884 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
7885 break;
7886
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007887 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007888 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00007889 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007890
7891 case OO_PlusEqual:
7892 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007893 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007894 // Fall through.
7895
7896 case OO_StarEqual:
7897 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007898 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007899 break;
7900
7901 case OO_PercentEqual:
7902 case OO_LessLessEqual:
7903 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
7904 case OO_AmpEqual:
7905 case OO_CaretEqual:
7906 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007907 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007908 break;
7909
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007910 case OO_Exclaim:
7911 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007912 break;
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007913
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007914 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007915 case OO_PipePipe:
7916 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007917 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007918
7919 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007920 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007921 break;
7922
7923 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007924 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007925 break;
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00007926
7927 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth3a0f3ef2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00007928 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthfe622742010-12-12 08:39:38 +00007929 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
7930 break;
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007931 }
7932}
7933
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007934/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
7935/// to the set of overloading candidates.
7936///
7937/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
7938/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
7939/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
7940/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007941void
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007942Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +00007943 bool Operator, SourceLocation Loc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00007944 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007945 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007946 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007947 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007948 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007949
John McCalla113e722010-01-26 06:04:06 +00007950 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
7951 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
7952 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
7953 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
7954 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
7955 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
7956
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007957 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +00007958 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Loc, Args, Fns);
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007959
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007960 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007961 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
7962 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7963 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007964 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007965 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007966 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007967 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007968 }
Douglas Gregor3fd95ce2009-03-13 00:33:25 +00007969
7970 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
7971 // set.
John McCall7edb5fd2010-01-26 07:16:45 +00007972 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007973 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007974 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007975 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007976 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007977
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007978 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
7979 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007980 } else
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007981 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007982 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00007983 Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor364e0212009-06-27 21:05:07 +00007984 }
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007985}
7986
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007987/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
7988/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007989bool
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007990isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00007991 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
7992 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00007993 SourceLocation Loc,
7994 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007995 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
7996 // functions.
7997 if (!Cand2.Viable)
7998 return Cand1.Viable;
7999 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8000 return false;
8001
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008002 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8003 //
8004 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8005 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8006 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8007 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8008 unsigned StartArg = 0;
8009 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8010 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008011
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008012 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008013 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
8014 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008015 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008016 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
8017 assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008018 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008019 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008020 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8021 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008022 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
8023 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8024 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8025 HasBetterConversion = true;
8026 break;
8027
8028 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8029 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8030 return false;
8031
8032 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8033 // Do nothing.
8034 break;
8035 }
8036 }
8037
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008038 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008039 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008040 if (HasBetterConversion)
8041 return true;
8042
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008043 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008044 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorccd47132010-06-08 21:03:17 +00008045 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008046 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
8047 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008048
8049 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
8050 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
8051 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregor3e15cc32009-07-07 23:38:56 +00008052 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor1f561c12009-08-02 23:46:29 +00008053 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00008054 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008055 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008056 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8057 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8058 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008059 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5c7bf422011-01-11 17:34:58 +00008060 : TPOC_Call,
Richard Smith66118c22013-09-11 00:52:39 +00008061 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
8062 Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008063 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregordfc331e2011-01-19 23:54:39 +00008064 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008065
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008066 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8067 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8068 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8069 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8070 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8071 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008072 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008073 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008074 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
Douglas Gregorb734e242012-02-22 17:32:19 +00008075 // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8076 // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8077 // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8078 // pointer or block.
8079 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind FuncResult
8080 = compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8081 if (FuncResult != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8082 return FuncResult;
8083
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008084 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8085 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregorf1991ea2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00008086 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
8087 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8088 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8089 return true;
8090
8091 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8092 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8093 return false;
8094
8095 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8096 // Do nothing
8097 break;
8098 }
8099 }
8100
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008101 return false;
8102}
8103
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008104/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008105/// within an overload candidate set.
8106///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008107/// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008108/// which overload resolution occurs.
8109///
James Dennettefce31f2012-06-22 08:10:18 +00008110/// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8111/// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008112///
8113/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008114OverloadingResult
8115OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008116 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth25ca4212011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008117 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008118 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008119 Best = end();
8120 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8121 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008122 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008123 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008124 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008125 }
8126
8127 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008128 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008129 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8130
8131 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8132 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008133 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008134 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008135 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008136 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregor8fcc5162010-09-12 08:07:23 +00008137 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008138 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008139 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008140 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008141 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008142
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008143 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008144 if (Best->Function &&
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008145 (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8146 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008147 return OR_Deleted;
8148
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00008149 return OR_Success;
8150}
8151
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008152namespace {
8153
8154enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8155 oc_function,
8156 oc_method,
8157 oc_constructor,
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008158 oc_function_template,
8159 oc_method_template,
8160 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008161 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8162 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008163 oc_implicit_move_constructor,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008164 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008165 oc_implicit_move_assignment,
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008166 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008167};
8168
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008169OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8170 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8171 std::string &Description) {
8172 bool isTemplate = false;
8173
8174 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8175 isTemplate = true;
8176 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8177 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8178 }
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008179
8180 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008181 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008182 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008183
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008184 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8185 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8186
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008187 if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8188 return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8189
8190 if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8191 return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8192
8193 assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8194 "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8195 return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008196 }
8197
8198 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8199 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8200 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008201 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008202 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008203
Sean Hunt82713172011-05-25 23:16:36 +00008204 if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8205 return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8206
Douglas Gregoref7d78b2012-02-10 08:36:38 +00008207 if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8208 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8209
8210 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8211 return oc_method;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008212 }
8213
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008214 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008215}
8216
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008217void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) {
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008218 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8219 if (!Ctor) return;
8220
8221 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8222 if (!Ctor) return;
8223
8224 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8225}
8226
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008227} // end anonymous namespace
8228
8229// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008230void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008231 std::string FnDesc;
8232 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008233 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8234 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8235 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8236 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008237 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallb1622a12010-01-06 09:43:14 +00008238}
8239
Nick Lewycky199e3702013-09-22 10:06:01 +00008240// Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008241// OverloadedExpr
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008242void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008243 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8244
8245 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8246 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8247
8248 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8249 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8250 I != IEnd; ++I) {
8251 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8252 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008253 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008254 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8255 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00008256 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00008257 }
8258 }
8259}
8260
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008261/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
8262/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8263/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008264void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8265 Sema &S,
8266 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8267 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8268 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8269 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008270 // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8271 // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8272 // refactoring here.
8273 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8274 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8275 AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8276 for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8277 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8278 break;
8279 ++CandsShown;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008280 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008281 }
Matt Beaumont-Gay45a37da2012-11-08 20:50:02 +00008282 if (I != E)
8283 S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008284}
8285
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008286namespace {
8287
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008288void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
8289 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8290 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008291 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8292 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8293
8294 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8295 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
8296 // conversion-slot index.
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008297 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008298 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008299 if (I == 0)
8300 isObjectArgument = true;
8301 else
8302 I--;
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008303 }
8304
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008305 std::string FnDesc;
8306 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8307
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008308 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8309 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8310 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008311
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008312 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008313 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008314 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8315 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8316 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00008317 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008318
8319 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8320 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8321 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8322 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008323 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall5920dbb2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00008324 return;
8325 }
8326
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008327 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8328 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008329 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8330 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8331 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8332 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8333 else {
8334 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8335 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8336 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8337 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8338 }
8339
8340 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8341 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008342 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8343 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8344
8345 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8346 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8347 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8348 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8349 << FromTy
8350 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8351 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008352 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008353 return;
8354 }
8355
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008356 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8b03132011-06-24 00:08:59 +00008357 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00008358 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8359 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8360 << FromTy
8361 << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8362 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8363 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8364 return;
8365 }
8366
Douglas Gregor028ea4b2011-04-26 23:16:46 +00008367 if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8368 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8369 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8370 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8371 << FromTy
8372 << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8373 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8374 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8375 return;
8376 }
8377
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008378 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8379 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8380
8381 if (isObjectArgument) {
8382 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8383 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8384 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8385 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8386 } else {
8387 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8388 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8389 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8390 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8391 }
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008392 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall651f3ee2010-01-14 03:28:57 +00008393 return;
8394 }
8395
Sebastian Redlfd2a00a2011-09-24 17:48:32 +00008396 // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8397 // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8398 if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8399 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8400 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8401 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8402 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8403 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8404 return;
8405 }
8406
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008407 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8408 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8409 // the failure.
8410 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8411 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8412 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8413 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8414 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8415 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8416 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8417 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008418 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall258b2032010-01-23 08:10:49 +00008419 return;
8420 }
8421
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008422 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008423 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008424 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8425 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8426 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8427 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8428 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8429 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008430 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008431 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008432 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008433 }
8434 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8435 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8436 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8437 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8438 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8439 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8440 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8441 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8442 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008443 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8444 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008445 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8446 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8447 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8448 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8449 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8450 } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8451 ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8452 FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008453 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8454 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8455 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8456 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8457 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8458 return;
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008459 }
Kaelyn Uhrain0d3317e2012-06-19 00:37:47 +00008460 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008461
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008462 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008463 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008464 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008465 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8466 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregor2f9d8742010-07-01 02:14:45 +00008467 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008468 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008469 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor85789812010-06-30 23:01:39 +00008470 return;
8471 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008472
Fariborz Jahanian909bcb32011-07-20 17:14:09 +00008473 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
8474 isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
8475 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8476 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8477 if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8478 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
8479 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8480 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8481 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8482 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8483 return;
8484 }
8485 }
8486
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008487 // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
8488 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
8489 FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008490 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008491 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
8492 << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
8493
8494 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
Benjamin Kramer1136ef02012-01-14 21:05:10 +00008495 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
8496 HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00008497 FDiag << *HI;
8498 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
8499
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008500 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008501}
8502
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008503/// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
8504/// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
8505/// over a candidate in any candidate set.
8506bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8507 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008508 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008509 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008510
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008511 // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008512 // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008513 // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
8514 // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
8515 // Just don't report anything.
8516 if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
8517 Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008518 return true;
8519
8520 if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
8521 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
8522 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8523 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
8524 } else {
8525 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
8526 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
8527 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
8528 }
8529
8530 return false;
8531}
8532
8533/// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
8534void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8535 assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
8536 "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
8537 " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
8538 " or too few arguments");
8539
8540 FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
8541
8542 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
8543 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
8544 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregor439d3c32011-05-05 00:13:13 +00008545
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008546 // at least / at most / exactly
8547 unsigned mode, modeCount;
8548 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008549 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregorf5c65ff2011-01-06 22:09:01 +00008550 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008551 mode = 0; // "at least"
8552 else
8553 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8554 modeCount = MinParams;
8555 } else {
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008556 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
8557 mode = 1; // "at most"
8558 else
8559 mode = 2; // "exactly"
8560 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
8561 }
8562
8563 std::string Description;
8564 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
8565
Richard Smithf7b80562012-05-11 05:16:41 +00008566 if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
8567 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
8568 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8569 << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
8570 else
8571 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
8572 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
8573 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008574 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008575}
8576
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008577/// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
8578void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8579 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
8580 if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
8581 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
8582}
Larisse Voufo8c5d4072013-07-19 22:53:23 +00008583
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008584TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
8585 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))
8586 return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
8587 else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated))
8588 return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate();
8589
8590 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
8591 " for bad deduction diagnosis");
8592}
8593
8594/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
8595void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated,
8596 DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
8597 unsigned NumArgs) {
8598 TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008599 NamedDecl *ParamD;
8600 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
8601 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
8602 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008603 switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008604 case Sema::TDK_Success:
8605 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
8606
8607 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008608 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008609 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8610 diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
8611 << ParamD->getDeclName();
8612 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008613 return;
8614 }
8615
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008616 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
8617 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
8618 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
8619
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008620 QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008621
8622 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
8623 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008624 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008625 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall49f4e1c2010-12-10 11:01:00 +00008626 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008627 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
8628
8629 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
8630 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
8631 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
8632 // done on dependent types).
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008633 QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008634
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008635 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
8636 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
8637 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall57e97782010-08-05 09:05:08 +00008638 return;
8639 }
8640
8641 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008642 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008643 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008644 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008645 which = 0;
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008646 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008647 which = 1;
8648 else {
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008649 which = 2;
8650 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008651
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008652 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8653 diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
8654 << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
8655 << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
8656 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregora9333192010-05-08 17:41:32 +00008657 return;
8658 }
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008659
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008660 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008661 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008662 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008663 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008664 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008665 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008666 else {
8667 int index = 0;
8668 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
8669 index = TTP->getIndex();
8670 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
8671 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
8672 index = NTTP->getIndex();
8673 else
8674 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008675 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008676 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008677 << (index + 1);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008678 }
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008679 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregorf1a84452010-05-08 19:15:54 +00008680 return;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008681
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008682 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8683 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008684 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregora18592e2010-05-08 18:13:28 +00008685 return;
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008686
8687 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008688 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8689 diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
8690 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008691 return;
8692
8693 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008694 // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008695 SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008696 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008697 DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008698 TemplateArgString = " ";
8699 TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008700 getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008701 }
8702
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008703 // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008704 PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008705 if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
8706 diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
8707 // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
8708 // name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
8709 S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
8710 << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
8711 return;
8712 }
8713
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008714 // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
8715 // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
8716 // formatted message in another diagnostic.
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00008717 SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008718 SourceRange R;
Richard Smith4493c0a2012-05-09 05:17:00 +00008719 if (PDiag) {
Richard Smithb8590f32012-05-07 09:03:25 +00008720 SFINAEArgString = ": ";
8721 R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
8722 PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
8723 }
8724
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008725 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8726 diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
8727 << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
8728 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
Douglas Gregorec20f462010-05-08 20:07:26 +00008729 return;
8730 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008731
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008732 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008733 OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr());
8734 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008735 diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008736 << R.Expression->getName();
Richard Smith0efa62f2013-01-31 04:03:12 +00008737 return;
8738 }
8739
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008740 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008741 // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008742 TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
8743 TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008744 if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
8745 SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
8746 TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
8747 TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
8748 if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
8749 SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
8750 if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
8751 SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
8752 // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
8753 // the same. This particular case is a bit difficult since:
8754 // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
8755 // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
8756 // name for types, not decls.
8757 // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008758 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008759 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
8760 << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
8761 return;
8762 }
8763 }
8764 }
Faisal Valifad9e132013-09-26 19:54:12 +00008765 // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
8766 // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
8767 // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
8768 // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008769 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
8770 diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
8771 << FirstTA << SecondTA;
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008772 return;
Richard Trieueef35f82013-04-08 21:11:40 +00008773 }
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008774 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
8775 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008776 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008777 S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
8778 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008779 return;
8780 }
8781}
8782
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008783/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
8784void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned NumArgs) {
8785 unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
8786 if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
8787 if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
8788 return;
8789 }
8790 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern
8791 Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs);
8792}
8793
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008794/// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
8795void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8796 FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8797 FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
8798
8799 Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
8800 CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
8801
8802 std::string FnDesc;
8803 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
8804
8805 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
8806 << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
8807}
8808
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008809/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
8810/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
8811///
8812/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
8813/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
8814/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
8815/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
8816/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
8817/// overload.
8818///
8819/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
8820/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
8821/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008822void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008823 unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008824 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8825
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008826 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis572bbec2011-06-23 00:41:50 +00008827 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
8828 S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008829 std::string FnDesc;
8830 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall3c80f572010-01-12 02:15:36 +00008831
8832 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +00008833 << FnKind << FnDesc
8834 << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008835 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008836 return;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008837 }
8838
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008839 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
8840 if (Cand->Viable) {
8841 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
8842 return;
8843 }
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008844
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008845 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
8846 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
8847 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
8848 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008849
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008850 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00008851 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCall342fec42010-02-01 18:53:26 +00008852
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00008853 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
8854 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregorc520c842010-04-12 23:42:09 +00008855 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008856 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008857
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008858 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
8859 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008860 for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008861 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
8862 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008863
John McCalladbb8f82010-01-13 09:16:55 +00008864 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
8865 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
8866 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
8867 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCall220ccbf2010-01-13 00:25:19 +00008868 }
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00008869
8870 case ovl_fail_bad_target:
8871 return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00008872 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008873}
8874
8875void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
8876 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
8877 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
8878 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
8879 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
8880 bool isLValueReference = false;
8881 bool isRValueReference = false;
8882 bool isPointer = false;
8883 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8884 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
8885 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8886 isLValueReference = true;
8887 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
8888 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
8889 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8890 isRValueReference = true;
8891 }
8892 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8893 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8894 isPointer = true;
8895 }
8896 // Desugar down to a function type.
8897 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
8898 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
8899 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
8900 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
8901 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
8902
8903 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
8904 << FnType;
Sebastian Redlf677ea32011-02-05 19:23:19 +00008905 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008906}
8907
8908void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00008909 StringRef Opc,
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008910 SourceLocation OpLoc,
8911 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008912 assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008913 std::string TypeStr("operator");
8914 TypeStr += Opc;
8915 TypeStr += "(";
8916 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008917 if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008918 TypeStr += ")";
8919 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8920 } else {
8921 TypeStr += ", ";
8922 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
8923 TypeStr += ")";
8924 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
8925 }
8926}
8927
8928void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
8929 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00008930 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008931 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
8932 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008933 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
8934 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
8935
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008936 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008937 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00008938 }
8939}
8940
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008941static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008942 if (Cand->Function)
8943 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008944 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00008945 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
8946 return SourceLocation();
8947}
8948
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00008949static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
Chandler Carruth78bf6802011-09-10 00:51:24 +00008950 switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008951 case Sema::TDK_Success:
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00008952 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008953
Douglas Gregorae19fbb2012-09-13 21:01:57 +00008954 case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008955 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
8956 return 1;
8957
8958 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
8959 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
8960 return 2;
8961
8962 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
8963 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Richard Smith29805ca2013-01-31 05:19:49 +00008964 case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008965 return 3;
8966
8967 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
8968 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
8969 return 4;
8970
8971 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
8972 return 5;
8973
8974 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
8975 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
8976 return 6;
8977 }
Benjamin Kramerafc5b152011-09-10 21:52:04 +00008978 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00008979}
8980
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008981struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
8982 Sema &S;
8983 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008984
8985 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
8986 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCallf3cf22b2010-01-16 03:50:16 +00008987 // Fast-path this check.
8988 if (L == R) return false;
8989
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00008990 // Order first by viability.
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008991 if (L->Viable) {
8992 if (!R->Viable) return true;
8993
8994 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
8995 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
8996 // that could exploit it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008997 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
8998 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00008999 } else if (R->Viable)
9000 return false;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009001
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009002 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009003
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009004 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
9005 if (!L->Viable) {
9006 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
9007 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9008 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9009 return false;
9010 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9011 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9012 return true;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009013
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009014 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
9015 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
9016 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
9017 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9018 return true;
9019
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009020 // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
9021 // comes first.
9022 unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9023 unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9024 numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
9025 numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009026 if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009027 if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
9028 return true;
9029 else
9030 return false;
Anna Zaksffe9edd2011-07-21 00:34:39 +00009031 }
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009032
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009033 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
9034 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009035 assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009036
9037 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall3a813372010-02-25 10:46:05 +00009038 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009039 for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009040 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
9041 L->Conversions[I],
9042 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009043 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9044 leftBetter++;
9045 break;
9046
9047 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9048 leftBetter--;
9049 break;
9050
9051 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9052 break;
9053 }
9054 }
9055 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
9056 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
9057
9058 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9059 return false;
9060
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009061 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
9062 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9063 return true;
9064
9065 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9066 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
Eli Friedmance1846e2011-10-14 23:10:30 +00009067 < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
Eli Friedman1c522f72011-10-14 21:52:24 +00009068 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9069 return false;
Kaelyn Uhrainfd641f92011-09-09 21:58:49 +00009070
John McCall1b77e732010-01-15 23:32:50 +00009071 // TODO: others?
9072 }
9073
9074 // Sort everything else by location.
9075 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9076 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9077
9078 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9079 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
9080 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
9081
9082 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009083 }
9084};
9085
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009086/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009087/// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009088void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009089 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009090 assert(!Cand->Viable);
9091
9092 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
9093 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
9094
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009095 // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
9096 bool Unfixable = false;
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009097 // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
9098 Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009099
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009100 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009101 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
Benjamin Kramer09dd3792012-01-14 16:32:05 +00009102 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009103 while (true) {
9104 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
9105 ConvIdx++;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009106 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009107 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009108 break;
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009109 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009110 }
9111
9112 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
9113 return;
9114
John McCallb1bdc622010-02-25 01:37:24 +00009115 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
9116 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
9117
Douglas Gregor23ef6c02010-04-16 17:45:54 +00009118 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009119 // operation somehow.
9120 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009121
9122 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9123 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9124
9125 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9126 QualType ConvType
9127 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9128 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9129 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9130 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9131 ArgIdx--;
9132 } else if (Cand->Function) {
9133 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9134 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9135 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9136 ArgIdx--;
9137 } else {
9138 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9139 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9140 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9141 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009142 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9143 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009144 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009145 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9146 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009147 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009148 return;
9149 }
9150
9151 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
9152 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
9153 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009154 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009155 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregor74eb6582010-04-16 17:51:22 +00009156 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009157 SuppressUserConversions,
John McCallf85e1932011-06-15 23:02:42 +00009158 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9159 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009160 S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009161 // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9162 if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
Anna Zaksf3546ee2011-07-28 19:46:48 +00009163 Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
Anna Zaksb89fe6b2011-07-19 19:49:12 +00009164 }
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009165 else
9166 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9167 }
9168}
9169
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009170} // end anonymous namespace
9171
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009172/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9173/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009174/// set.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009175void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9176 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009177 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
David Blaikie0bea8632012-10-08 01:11:04 +00009178 StringRef Opc,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009179 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009180 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
9181 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009182 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009183 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9184 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009185 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009186 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009187 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009188 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009189 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9190 Cands.push_back(Cand);
9191 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
9192 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCall717e8912010-01-23 05:17:32 +00009193 }
9194 }
9195
John McCallbf65c0b2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00009196 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009197 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009198
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009199 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009200
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009201 SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009202 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009203 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall81201622010-01-08 04:41:39 +00009204 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9205 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor621b3932008-11-21 02:54:28 +00009206
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009207 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9208 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9209 // candidate list.
Douglas Gregordc7b6412012-10-23 23:11:23 +00009210 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009211 break;
9212 }
9213 ++CandsShown;
9214
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009215 if (Cand->Function)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009216 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009217 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009218 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009219 else {
9220 assert(Cand->Viable &&
9221 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009222 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9223 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9224 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9225 //
9226 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9227 // different ambiguities, though.
9228 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009229 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009230 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9231 }
John McCalla1d7d622010-01-08 00:58:21 +00009232
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +00009233 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009234 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +00009235 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009236 }
Jeffrey Yasskin5edbdcc2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00009237
9238 if (I != E)
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +00009239 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009240}
9241
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009242static SourceLocation
9243GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
9244 return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
9245 : SourceLocation();
9246}
9247
9248struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
9249 Sema &S;
9250 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9251
9252 bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
9253 const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
9254 // Fast-path this check.
9255 if (L == R)
9256 return false;
9257
9258 // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
9259
9260 // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
9261 if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9262 return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
9263 RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9264
9265 // Sort everything else by location.
9266 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9267 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9268
9269 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9270 if (LLoc.isInvalid())
9271 return false;
9272 if (RLoc.isInvalid())
9273 return true;
9274
9275 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9276 }
9277};
9278
9279/// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
9280/// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
9281/// deductions.
9282void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) {
9283 DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern
9284 DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0);
9285}
9286
9287void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
9288 for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
9289 i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
9290 }
9291}
9292
9293void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
9294 destroyCandidates();
9295 Candidates.clear();
9296}
9297
9298/// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
9299/// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
9300/// the candidate set.
9301/// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
9302/// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
9303void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
9304 // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
9305 // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
9306 // and sort those.
9307 SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
9308 Cands.reserve(size());
9309 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9310 if (Cand->Specialization)
9311 Cands.push_back(Cand);
9312 // Otherwise, this is a non matching builtin candidate. We do not,
9313 // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9314 }
9315
9316 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9317 CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
9318
9319 // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
9320 // for generalization purposes (?).
9321 const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9322
9323 SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
9324 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9325 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9326 TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
9327
9328 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
9329 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9330 // candidate list.
9331 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9332 break;
9333 ++CandsShown;
9334
9335 assert(Cand->Specialization &&
9336 "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9337 Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S);
9338 }
9339
9340 if (I != E)
9341 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9342}
9343
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009344// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
9345// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9346// R (A) --> R(A)
9347// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9348// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9349// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9350QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9351 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9352 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9353 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9354 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9355 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9356 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9357 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009358 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009359 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9360 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9361 Ret =
9362 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9363 return Ret;
9364}
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009365
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009366// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9367// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9368class AddressOfFunctionResolver
9369{
9370 Sema& S;
9371 Expr* SourceExpr;
9372 const QualType& TargetType;
9373 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9374
9375 bool Complain;
9376 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9377 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009378
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009379 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9380 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009381 bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009382
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009383 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
9384 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
9385 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
Chris Lattner5f9e2722011-07-23 10:55:15 +00009386 SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009387 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009388
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009389public:
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009390 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
9391 const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
9392 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
9393 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
9394 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
9395 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
9396 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009397 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009398 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
9399 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
9400 FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009401 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009402
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009403 if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
9404 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
9405 if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
9406 !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
9407 StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
9408 } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9409 DeclAccessPair dap;
9410 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9411 OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
9412 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
9413 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9414 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
9415 // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
9416 // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
9417 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009418
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009419 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
9420 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
9421 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
9422 return;
Chandler Carruth90434232011-03-29 08:08:18 +00009423 }
9424
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009425 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009426 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009427 return;
Douglas Gregor83314aa2009-07-08 20:55:45 +00009428 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009429
9430 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
9431 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009432
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009433 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
9434 // C++ [over.over]p4:
9435 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
9436 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
9437 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
9438 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
9439 else
9440 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
9441 }
9442 }
9443 }
9444
9445private:
9446 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
9447 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
9448 }
9449
9450 // [ToType] [Return]
9451
9452 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9453 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
9454 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
9455 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
9456 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
9457 }
9458
9459 // return true if any matching specializations were found
9460 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
9461 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
9462 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
9463 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9464 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
9465 // static when converting to member pointer.
9466 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9467 return false;
9468 }
9469 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9470 return false;
9471
9472 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9473 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9474 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9475 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9476 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9477 // overloaded functions considered.
9478 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009479 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009480 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
9481 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
9482 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
9483 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009484 Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009485 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9486 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
9487 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
9488 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009489 return false;
9490 }
9491
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009492 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
9493 // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009494 // This function template specicalization works.
9495 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009496 assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
9497 Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
9498 Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009499 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
9500 return true;
9501 }
9502
9503 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
9504 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009505 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00009506 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
9507 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009508 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9509 return false;
9510 }
9511 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
9512 return false;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009513
Chandler Carruthbd647292009-12-29 06:17:27 +00009514 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +00009515 if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
Peter Collingbourne78dd67e2011-10-02 23:49:40 +00009516 if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
9517 if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
9518 return false;
9519
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009520 // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
9521 // now.
9522 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
9523 FunDecl->getResultType()->isUndeducedType() &&
9524 S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain))
9525 return false;
9526
Douglas Gregor43c79c22009-12-09 00:47:37 +00009527 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009528 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
9529 FunDecl->getType()) ||
Chandler Carruth18e04612011-06-18 01:19:03 +00009530 S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
9531 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009532 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
9533 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009534 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009535 return true;
Douglas Gregor00aeb522009-07-08 23:33:52 +00009536 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00009537 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009538
9539 return false;
9540 }
9541
9542 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
9543 bool Ret = false;
9544
9545 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
9546 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
9547 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9548 return false;
9549
9550 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9551 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9552 I != E; ++I) {
9553 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
9554 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
9555
9556 // C++ [over.over]p3:
9557 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
9558 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
9559 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
9560 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
9561 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
9562 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9563 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
9564 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
9565 Ret = true;
9566 }
9567 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
9568 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
9569 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
9570 Ret = true;
9571 }
9572 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
9573 return Ret;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009574 }
9575
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009576 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +00009577 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
9578 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
9579 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
9580 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
9581 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
9582
9583 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
9584 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
9585 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
9586 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009587
9588 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
9589 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
9590 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009591
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009592 // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
9593 // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
9594 UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
Richard Smith4ad09e62013-09-10 22:59:25 +00009595 MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009596 SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
9597 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0]
9598 .second->getDeclName(),
9599 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template,
9600 Complain, TargetFunctionType);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009601
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009602 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
9603 // Make it the first and only element
9604 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
9605 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
9606 Matches.resize(1);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00009607 }
9608 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009609
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009610 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
9611 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
9612 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
9613 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
9614 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
9615 ++I;
9616 else {
9617 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
9618 Matches.set_size(N);
9619 }
9620 }
9621 }
9622
9623public:
9624 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
9625 assert(Matches.empty());
9626 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
9627 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
9628 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith72a36a12013-08-14 00:00:44 +00009629 if (FailedCandidates.empty())
9630 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
9631 else {
9632 // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
9633 // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
9634 // normally.
9635 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
9636 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
9637 I != IEnd; ++I)
9638 if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
9639 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
9640 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType);
9641 FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
9642 }
9643 }
9644
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009645 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9646 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
9647 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
9648 }
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009649
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009650 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
9651 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
9652 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
9653 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
9654 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
9655 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9656 }
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009657
9658 bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
9659 return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
9660 }
9661
9662 void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
9663 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
9664 diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9665 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
9666 }
9667
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009668 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
9669 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
9670 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
9671 }
9672
9673 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
9674 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
9675 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9676 << OvlExpr->getName()
9677 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
Richard Trieu6efd4c52011-11-23 22:32:32 +00009678 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009679 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009680
9681 bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
9682
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009683 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
9684
9685 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
9686 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9687 return Matches[0].second;
9688 }
9689
9690 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
9691 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
9692 return &Matches[0].first;
9693 }
9694};
9695
9696/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
9697/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
9698/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
9699/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
9700///
9701/// @code
9702/// int f(double);
9703/// int f(int);
9704///
9705/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
9706/// @endcode
9707///
9708/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
9709/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
9710/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
9711FunctionDecl *
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009712Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
9713 QualType TargetType,
9714 bool Complain,
9715 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
9716 bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009717 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009718
9719 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
9720 Complain);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009721 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
9722 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009723 if (NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009724 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
9725 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
9726 else
9727 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
9728 }
9729 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
9730 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
9731 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
9732 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
9733 assert(Fn);
9734 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
David Majnemer576a9af2013-08-01 06:13:59 +00009735 if (Complain) {
9736 if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
9737 Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
9738 else
9739 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
9740 }
Sebastian Redl07ab2022009-10-17 21:12:09 +00009741 }
Abramo Bagnara22c107b2011-11-19 11:44:21 +00009742
9743 if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
9744 *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009745 return Fn;
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009746}
9747
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009748/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009749/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
9750///
9751/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
9752/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009753/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009754/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
Alp Toker8b407722013-10-20 18:48:56 +00009755///
9756/// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
9757/// returned.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009758FunctionDecl *
9759Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
9760 bool Complain,
9761 DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009762 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9763 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
9764 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009765 // C++ [over.over]p1:
9766 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
9767 // operator.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009768
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009769 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009770 if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009771 return 0;
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00009772
9773 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009774 ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009775 TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009776
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009777 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
9778 // whose type matches exactly.
9779 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009780 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
9781 E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009782 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
9783 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009784 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
9785 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
9786 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009787 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregor66a8c9a2010-07-14 23:20:53 +00009788 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
9789 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009790
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009791 // C++ [over.over]p2:
9792 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
9793 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
9794 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
9795 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
9796 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009797 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009798 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009799 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
9800 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor092140a2013-04-17 08:45:07 +00009801 Specialization, Info,
9802 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
Larisse Voufo43847122013-07-19 23:00:19 +00009803 // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
9804 // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
9805 FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
9806 .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
9807 MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009808 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009809 }
9810
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009811 assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
9812
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009813 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009814 if (Matched) {
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009815 if (Complain) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009816 Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
9817 << ovl->getName();
9818 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009819 }
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009820 return 0;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009821 }
Douglas Gregor1be8eec2011-02-19 21:32:49 +00009822
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009823 Matched = Specialization;
9824 if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009825 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009826
Richard Smith60e141e2013-05-04 07:00:32 +00009827 if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus1y &&
9828 Matched->getResultType()->isUndeducedType() &&
9829 DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
9830 return 0;
9831
Douglas Gregor4b52e252009-12-21 23:17:24 +00009832 return Matched;
9833}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009834
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009835
9836
9837
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009838// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
9839// because it identifies a single function template specialization.
9840//
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009841// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009842//
9843// Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
9844// expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded. Always
9845// returns true if 'complain' is set.
9846bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9847 ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
9848 bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009849 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009850 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009851 assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009852
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009853 OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009854
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009855 DeclAccessPair found;
9856 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
9857 if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9858 ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +00009859 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009860 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9861 return true;
9862 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009863
9864 // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
9865 // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
9866 // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
9867 // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
9868 if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
9869 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
9870 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009871 if (!complain) return false;
9872
9873 Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
9874 diag::err_bound_member_function)
9875 << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
9876
9877 // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
9878 // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
9879 // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
9880 // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
9881 // the static candidates were rejected.
9882 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9883 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009884 }
Douglas Gregordb2eae62011-03-16 19:16:25 +00009885
Sylvestre Ledru43e3dee2012-07-31 06:56:50 +00009886 // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009887 SingleFunctionExpression =
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009888 Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009889
9890 // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009891 if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009892 SingleFunctionExpression =
9893 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009894 if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
9895 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9896 return true;
9897 }
9898 }
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009899 }
9900
9901 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
9902 if (complain) {
9903 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
9904 << ovl.Expression->getName()
9905 << DestTypeForComplaining
9906 << OpRangeForComplaining
9907 << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009908 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
9909
9910 SrcExpr = ExprError();
9911 return true;
9912 }
9913
9914 return false;
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +00009915 }
9916
John McCall6dbba4f2011-10-11 23:14:30 +00009917 SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
9918 return true;
Douglas Gregorfadb53b2011-03-12 01:48:56 +00009919}
9920
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009921/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
9922static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009923 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009924 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009925 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009926 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009927 bool PartialOverloading,
9928 bool KnownValid) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009929 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009930 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
9931 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
9932
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009933 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009934 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
9935 assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
9936 return;
9937 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009938 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
9939 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009940 return;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009941 }
9942
9943 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
9944 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +00009945 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009946 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009947 return;
9948 }
9949
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +00009950 assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009951}
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009952
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009953/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
9954/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009955void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +00009956 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009957 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
9958 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009959
9960#ifndef NDEBUG
9961 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
9962 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009963 //
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009964 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
9965 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
9966 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
9967 //
9968 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
9969 //
9970 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009971 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +00009972 //
9973 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
9974 // template
9975 //
9976 // then Y is empty.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009977
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009978 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
9979 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9980 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9981 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
9982 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
9983 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
9984 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009985 }
9986 }
9987#endif
9988
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009989 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
9990 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor67714232011-03-03 02:41:12 +00009991 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00009992 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9993 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
9994 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
9995 }
9996
9997 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
9998 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +00009999 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10000 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
10001 /*KnownValid*/ true);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010002
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010003 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010004 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
Richard Smithf5cd5cc2012-02-25 06:24:24 +000010005 ULE->getExprLoc(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010006 Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010007 CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregor9c6a0e92009-09-22 15:41:20 +000010008}
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010009
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010010/// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
10011/// a different namespace.
10012static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
10013 switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
10014 case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
10015 case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
10016 return false;
10017
10018 default:
10019 return true;
10020 }
10021}
10022
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010023/// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
10024/// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
10025/// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
10026/// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
10027///
10028/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10029static bool
10030DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
10031 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
10032 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010033 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010034 if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
10035 return false;
10036
10037 for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
Nick Lewycky5a7120c2012-03-14 20:41:00 +000010038 if (DC->isTransparentContext())
10039 continue;
10040
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010041 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
10042
10043 if (!R.empty()) {
10044 R.suppressDiagnostics();
10045
10046 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
10047 // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
10048 // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
10049 R.clear();
10050 return false;
10051 }
10052
10053 OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
10054 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
10055 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010056 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010057 Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010058
10059 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010060 if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010061 // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
10062 // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010063 R.clear();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010064 return false;
Richard Smith2ced0442011-06-26 22:19:54 +000010065 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010066
10067 // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
10068 // declaring the function there instead.
10069 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
10070 Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
John McCall42f48fb2012-08-24 20:38:34 +000010071 SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010072 AssociatedNamespaces,
10073 AssociatedClasses);
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010074 Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010075 if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
10076 DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
10077 for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
10078 it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
10079 end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
10080 // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
10081 if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
10082 continue;
Richard Smith19e0d952012-12-22 02:46:14 +000010083
Richard Smithd3ff3252013-06-12 22:56:54 +000010084 // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
10085 // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
10086 NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
10087 if (NS &&
10088 NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
10089 continue;
10090
10091 SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
10092 }
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010093 }
10094
10095 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10096 << R.getLookupName();
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010097 if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010098 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10099 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10100 << R.getLookupName() << 0;
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010101 } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010102 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10103 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
Chandler Carruth74d487e2011-06-05 23:36:55 +000010104 << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010105 } else {
10106 // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
10107 // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
10108 // a localized representation of a list of items.
10109 SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10110 diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10111 << R.getLookupName() << 2;
10112 }
10113
10114 // Try to recover by calling this function.
10115 return true;
10116 }
10117
10118 R.clear();
10119 }
10120
10121 return false;
10122}
10123
10124/// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
10125/// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
10126/// was defined.
10127///
10128/// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10129static bool
10130DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
10131 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Dmitri Gribenkocfa88f82013-01-12 19:30:44 +000010132 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010133 DeclarationName OpName =
10134 SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10135 LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
10136 return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010137 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010138}
10139
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010140namespace {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010141class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
10142 Sema &SemaRef;
10143public:
10144 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
10145 assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
10146 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
10147 }
10148
10149 ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
10150 SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
10151 }
10152};
10153
Kaelyn Uhrain60a09dc2012-01-25 18:37:44 +000010154}
10155
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010156/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
10157///
10158/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010159static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1aae80b2010-04-14 20:27:54 +000010160BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010161 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10162 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010163 llvm::MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010164 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010165 bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
Richard Smithe49ff3e2012-09-25 04:46:05 +000010166 // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
10167 // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
10168 //
10169 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
10170 // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
10171 //
10172 if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
10173 return ExprError();
10174 BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010175
10176 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010177 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010178 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010179
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010180 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010181 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010182 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10183 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10184 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10185 }
10186
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010187 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
10188 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Kaelyn Uhrain761695f2013-07-08 23:13:39 +000010189 FunctionCallFilterCCC Validator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
10190 ExplicitTemplateArgs != 0);
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010191 NoTypoCorrectionCCC RejectAll;
10192 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC = AllowTypoCorrection ?
10193 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&Validator :
10194 (CorrectionCandidateCallback*)&RejectAll;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010195 if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010196 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args) &&
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010197 (!EmptyLookup ||
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010198 SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, *CCC,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010199 ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010200 return ExprError();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010201
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010202 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10203
10204 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
10205 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010206 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010207 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010208 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
10209 R, ExplicitTemplateArgs);
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010210 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000010211 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
Abramo Bagnara9d9922a2012-02-06 14:31:00 +000010212 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010213 else
10214 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10215
10216 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000010217 return ExprError();
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010218
10219 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010220 // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010221 // end up here.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010222 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010223 MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10224 RParenLoc);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010225}
Douglas Gregord7a95972010-06-08 17:35:15 +000010226
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010227/// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10228/// the given function.
10229/// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10230bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10231 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010232 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010233 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10234 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10235 ExprResult *Result) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010236#ifndef NDEBUG
10237 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10238 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10239 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10240
10241 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10242 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10243 FunctionDecl *F;
10244 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10245 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10246 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
David Blaikieb219cfc2011-09-23 05:06:16 +000010247 llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010248
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010249 // We don't perform ADL in C.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010250 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000010251 }
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010252#endif
10253
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010254 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010255 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010256 *Result = ExprError();
10257 return true;
10258 }
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +000010259
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010260 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10261 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010262 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010263
10264 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010265 // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
10266 // out if it fails.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010267 if (CandidateSet->empty()) {
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010268 // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10269 // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010270 // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010271 // classes.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000010272 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftMode && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
Francois Pichetc8ff9152011-11-25 01:10:54 +000010273 (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010274 CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010275 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10276 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010277 CE->setTypeDependent(true);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010278 *Result = Owned(CE);
10279 return true;
Sebastian Redl14b0c192011-09-24 17:48:00 +000010280 }
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010281 return false;
Francois Pichet0f74d1e2011-09-07 00:14:57 +000010282 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +000010283
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010284 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010285 return false;
10286}
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010287
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010288/// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10289/// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10290/// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10291static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10292 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10293 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010294 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010295 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10296 Expr *ExecConfig,
10297 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10298 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10299 OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10300 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10301 if (CandidateSet->empty())
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010302 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010303 RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10304 AllowTypoCorrection);
10305
10306 switch (OverloadResult) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010307 case OR_Success: {
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010308 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010309 SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000010310 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
10311 return ExprError();
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010312 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010313 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10314 ExecConfig);
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010315 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010316
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010317 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10318 // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
10319 // have meant to call.
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010320 ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010321 Args, RParenLoc,
Kaelyn Uhrain3943b1c2012-01-25 21:11:35 +000010322 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
10323 AllowTypoCorrection);
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010324 if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
10325 return Recovery;
10326
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010327 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010328 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010329 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010330 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010331 break;
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010332 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010333
10334 case OR_Ambiguous:
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010335 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010336 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010337 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010338 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000010339
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010340 case OR_Deleted: {
10341 SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
10342 << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
10343 << ULE->getName()
10344 << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
10345 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010346 CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis0d579b62011-11-04 15:58:13 +000010347
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010348 // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
10349 // the call in the AST.
10350 FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
10351 Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010352 return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
10353 ExecConfig);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010354 }
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010355 }
10356
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000010357 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +000010358 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorf6b89692008-11-26 05:54:23 +000010359}
10360
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010361/// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
10362/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
10363/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
10364/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
10365/// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
10366/// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
10367ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10368 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10369 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010370 MultiExprArg Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010371 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10372 Expr *ExecConfig,
10373 bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10374 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
10375 ExprResult result;
10376
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010377 if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
10378 &result))
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010379 return result;
10380
10381 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10382 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
10383 CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
10384
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000010385 return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000010386 RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
10387 &Best, OverloadResult,
10388 AllowTypoCorrection);
10389}
10390
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010391static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +000010392 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
10393 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
10394}
10395
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010396/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10397/// operator.
10398///
10399/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
10400///
10401/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10402/// operator.
10403///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010404/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010405/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10406/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10407/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10408/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10409/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
10410///
James Dennett8da16872012-06-22 10:32:46 +000010411/// \param Input The input argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010412ExprResult
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010413Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
10414 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010415 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010416 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010417
10418 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10419 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
10420 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010421 // TODO: provide better source location info.
10422 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010423
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010424 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
10425 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010426
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010427 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
10428 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010429
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010430 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
10431 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
10432 // post-decrement.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010433 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010434 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +000010435 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
10436 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010437 NumArgs = 2;
10438 }
10439
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010440 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
10441
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010442 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010443 if (Fns.empty())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010444 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010445 Opc,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010446 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010447 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor1ec8ef72010-06-17 15:46:20 +000010448 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010449
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010450 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010451 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010452 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010453 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010454 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
10455 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010456 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray,
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010457 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010458 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010459 OpLoc, false));
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010460 }
10461
10462 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010463 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010464
10465 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010466 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010467
10468 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010469 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010470
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010471 // Add candidates from ADL.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010472 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true, OpLoc,
10473 ArgsArray, /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010474 CandidateSet);
10475
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010476 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010477 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010478
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010479 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10480
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010481 // Perform overload resolution.
10482 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010483 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010484 case OR_Success: {
10485 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10486 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010487
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010488 if (FnDecl) {
10489 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10490 // operator.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010491
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010492 // Convert the arguments.
10493 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010494 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010495
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010496 ExprResult InputRes =
10497 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10498 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10499 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010500 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010501 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010502 } else {
10503 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010504 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010505 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010506 Context,
Douglas Gregorbaecfed2009-12-23 00:02:00 +000010507 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010508 SourceLocation(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010509 Input);
Douglas Gregore1a5c172009-12-23 17:40:29 +000010510 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010511 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010512 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010513 }
10514
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010515 // Determine the result type.
10516 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10517 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10518 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010519
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010520 // Build the actual expression node.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010521 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010522 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010523 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10524 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010525
Eli Friedman4c3b8962009-11-18 03:58:17 +000010526 Args[0] = Input;
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010527 CallExpr *TheCall =
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010528 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(), ArgsArray,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010529 ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
John McCallb697e082010-05-06 18:15:07 +000010530
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010531 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson26a2a072009-10-13 21:19:37 +000010532 FnDecl))
10533 return ExprError();
10534
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010535 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010536 } else {
10537 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10538 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10539 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010540 ExprResult InputRes =
10541 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10542 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10543 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
10544 return ExprError();
10545 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010546 break;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010547 }
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010548 }
10549
10550 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010551 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10552 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10553 // defined too late to be candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010554 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010555 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10556 return ExprError();
10557
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010558 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
10559 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
10560 break;
10561
10562 case OR_Ambiguous:
10563 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
10564 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10565 << Input->getType()
10566 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010567 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010568 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
10569 return ExprError();
10570
10571 case OR_Deleted:
10572 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10573 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10574 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10575 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10576 << Input->getSourceRange();
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010577 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010578 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010579 return ExprError();
10580 }
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010581
10582 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
10583 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
10584 // build a built-in operation.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010585 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010586}
10587
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010588/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
10589/// operator.
10590///
10591/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
10592///
10593/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
10594/// operator.
10595///
James Dennett40ae6662012-06-22 08:52:37 +000010596/// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010597/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
10598/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
10599/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
10600/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
10601/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
10602///
10603/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
10604/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010605ExprResult
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010606Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000010607 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010608 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010609 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010610 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010611 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010612
10613 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
10614 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10615 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10616
10617 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10618 // expression.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010619 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010620 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010621 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010622 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010623 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010624 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010625 Context.DependentTy,
10626 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010627 OpLoc,
10628 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010629
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010630 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
10631 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010632 VK_LValue,
10633 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010634 Context.DependentTy,
10635 Context.DependentTy,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010636 OpLoc,
10637 FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +000010638 }
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010639
10640 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010641 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010642 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
10643 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010644 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010645 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
10646 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
10647 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010648 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010649 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args,
10650 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
10651 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract));
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010652 }
10653
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010654 // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
10655 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10656 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010657
John McCall3c3b7f92011-10-25 17:37:35 +000010658 // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
10659 // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
10660 assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010661 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10662 return ExprError();
10663
Sebastian Redl275c2b42009-11-18 23:10:33 +000010664 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
10665 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
10666 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
10667 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
10668 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
10669 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010670 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010671 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010672
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010673 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
10674 // create a built-in binary operator.
10675 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
10676 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
10677
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +000010678 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010679 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010680
10681 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010682 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010683
10684 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010685 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010686
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010687 // Add candidates from ADL.
10688 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010689 OpLoc, Args,
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +000010690 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
10691 CandidateSet);
10692
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010693 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010694 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010695
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010696 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10697
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010698 // Perform overload resolution.
10699 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010700 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +000010701 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010702 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10703 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10704
10705 if (FnDecl) {
10706 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10707 // operator.
10708
10709 // Convert the arguments.
10710 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010711 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010712 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall5357b612010-01-28 01:42:12 +000010713
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010714 ExprResult Arg1 =
10715 PerformCopyInitialization(
10716 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10717 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10718 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010719 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010720 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010721
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010722 ExprResult Arg0 =
10723 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10724 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10725 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010726 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010727 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010728 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010729 } else {
10730 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010731 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
10732 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10733 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
10734 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010735 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010736 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010737
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010738 ExprResult Arg1 =
10739 PerformCopyInitialization(
10740 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
10741 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
10742 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor4c2458a2009-12-22 21:44:34 +000010743 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
10744 return ExprError();
10745 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
10746 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010747 }
10748
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010749 // Determine the result type.
10750 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10751 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10752 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010753
10754 // Build the actual expression node.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010755 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010756 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010757 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010758 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10759 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010760
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010761 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010762 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010763 Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
10764 FPFeatures.fp_contract);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010765
10766 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000010767 FnDecl))
10768 return ExprError();
10769
Nick Lewycky9b7ea0d2013-01-24 02:03:08 +000010770 ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
10771 // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
10772 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
10773 ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
10774 checkCall(FnDecl, ArgsArray, 0, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
10775 TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
10776
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010777 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010778 } else {
10779 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10780 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10781 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010782 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10783 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10784 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10785 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010786 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010787 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010788
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010789 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
10790 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
10791 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
10792 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
10793 return ExprError();
10794 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010795 break;
10796 }
10797 }
10798
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010799 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
10800 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
10801 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
10802 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
10803 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010804 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010805 break;
10806
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000010807 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
10808 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
10809 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010810 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010811 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000010812 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010813 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
10814 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010815 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman3f93d4c2013-08-28 20:35:35 +000010816 if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
10817 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
10818 << Args[0]->getType()
10819 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10820 }
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010821 } else {
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010822 // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
10823 // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
10824 // defined too late to be candidates.
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010825 if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
Richard Smithf50e88a2011-06-05 22:42:48 +000010826 // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
10827 return ExprError();
10828
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010829 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
10830 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
10831 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl8593c782009-05-21 11:50:50 +000010832 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010833 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010834 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
10835 if (Result.isInvalid())
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010836 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010837 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000010838 return Result;
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010839 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010840
10841 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010842 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010843 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000010844 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010845 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010846 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010847 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010848 return ExprError();
10849
10850 case OR_Deleted:
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010851 if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
10852 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10853 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010854 << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
10855 << getSpecialMember(Method);
Richard Smith5bdaac52012-04-02 20:59:25 +000010856
Richard Smith0f46e642012-12-28 12:23:24 +000010857 // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
10858 // explain why it's deleted.
10859 NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
10860 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore4e68d42012-02-15 19:33:52 +000010861 } else {
10862 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
10863 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
10864 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
10865 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
10866 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
10867 }
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000010868 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
Eli Friedman1795d372011-08-26 19:46:22 +000010869 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010870 return ExprError();
John McCall1d318332010-01-12 00:44:57 +000010871 }
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010872
Douglas Gregor33074752009-09-30 21:46:01 +000010873 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregorc3384cb2009-08-26 17:08:25 +000010874 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +000010875}
10876
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010877ExprResult
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010878Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
10879 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010880 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
10881 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010882 DeclarationName OpName =
10883 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
10884
10885 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
10886 // expression.
10887 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
10888
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010889 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +000010890 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
10891 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10892 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000010893 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregorbebbe0d2010-12-15 01:34:56 +000010894 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000010895 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +000010896 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
10897 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
10898 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000010899 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010900
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010901 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010902 Args,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010903 Context.DependentTy,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010904 VK_RValue,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010905 RLoc, false));
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010906 }
10907
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000010908 // Handle placeholders on both operands.
10909 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
10910 return ExprError();
10911 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
10912 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000010913
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010914 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000010915 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010916
10917 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
10918
10919 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010920 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010921
10922 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000010923 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010924
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010925 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
10926
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010927 // Perform overload resolution.
10928 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000010929 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010930 case OR_Success: {
10931 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
10932 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
10933
10934 if (FnDecl) {
10935 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
10936 // operator.
10937
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000010938 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +000010939
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010940 // Convert the arguments.
10941 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010942 ExprResult Arg0 =
10943 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
10944 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10945 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010946 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010947 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010948
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010949 // Convert the arguments.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000010950 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010951 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000010952 Context,
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010953 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000010954 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlsson38f88ab2010-01-29 18:37:50 +000010955 Owned(Args[1]));
10956 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
10957 return ExprError();
10958
10959 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
10960
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010961 // Determine the result type
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000010962 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
10963 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10964 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010965
10966 // Build the actual expression node.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010967 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
10968 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010969 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000010970 Best->FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000010971 HadMultipleCandidates,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000010972 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
10973 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010974 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10975 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010976
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010977 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10978 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000010979 FnExpr.take(), Args,
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000010980 ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
10981 false);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010982
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010983 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010984 FnDecl))
10985 return ExprError();
10986
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000010987 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010988 } else {
10989 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
10990 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
10991 // operator node.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010992 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
10993 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
10994 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
10995 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000010996 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000010997 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
10998
10999 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11000 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11001 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11002 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11003 return ExprError();
11004 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011005
11006 break;
11007 }
11008 }
11009
11010 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011011 if (CandidateSet.empty())
11012 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11013 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
11014 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11015 else
11016 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
11017 << Args[0]->getType()
11018 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011019 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011020 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011021 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011022 }
11023
11024 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011025 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011026 << "[]"
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011027 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11028 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011029 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011030 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011031 return ExprError();
11032
11033 case OR_Deleted:
11034 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11035 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011036 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011037 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011038 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011039 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011040 return ExprError();
11041 }
11042
11043 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011044 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +000011045}
11046
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011047/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
11048/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
11049/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
11050/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
11051/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011052/// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
11053/// member function.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011054ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011055Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011056 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11057 MultiExprArg Args,
11058 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011059 assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
11060 MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11061
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011062 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
11063 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011064 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011065
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011066 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
11067 if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11068 assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
11069 assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
11070
11071 QualType fnType =
11072 op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11073
11074 const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11075 QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
11076 ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
11077
11078 // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
11079 // member function we're calling.
11080 Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
11081
11082 QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
11083 if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
11084 objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11085 Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
11086
11087 Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
11088 difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
11089 difference.removeAddressSpace();
11090 if (difference) {
11091 std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
11092 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
11093 << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
11094 << qualsString
11095 << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
11096 }
11097
11098 CXXMemberCallExpr *call
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011099 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011100 resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
11101
11102 if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011103 op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011104 call, 0))
11105 return ExprError();
11106
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011107 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011108 return ExprError();
11109
Richard Trieue2a90b82013-06-22 02:30:38 +000011110 if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
11111 return ExprError();
11112
John McCall864c0412011-04-26 20:42:42 +000011113 return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
11114 }
11115
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011116 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011117 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011118 return ExprError();
11119
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011120 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011121 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCallbb6fb462010-04-08 00:13:37 +000011122 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011123 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011124 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11125 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011126 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011127 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011128 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011129 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011130 } else {
11131 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +000011132 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011133
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011134 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011135 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
11136 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
11137 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011138
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011139 // Add overload candidates
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011140 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011141
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011142 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11143 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11144 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11145 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11146 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11147 }
11148
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011149 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
11150 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11151
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011152 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
11153 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
11154 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
11155 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
11156
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011157
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011158 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
David Blaikie4e4d0842012-03-11 07:00:24 +000011159 if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011160 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011161 Args, CandidateSet);
Francois Pichetdbee3412011-01-18 05:04:39 +000011162 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011163 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
11164 // non-template member function.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011165 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregor3eefb1c2009-10-24 04:59:53 +000011166 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011167
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011168 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011169 ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011170 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011171 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011172 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011173 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011174 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011175 Args, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011176 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011177 }
Douglas Gregordec06662009-08-21 18:42:58 +000011178 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011179
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011180 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
11181
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011182 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11183
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011184 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011185 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky7663f392010-11-20 01:29:55 +000011186 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011187 case OR_Success:
11188 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011189 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011190 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011191 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11192 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011193 // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
11194 // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
11195 // called on both.
11196 // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
11197 // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
11198 // being used.
11199 if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11200 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11201 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011202 break;
11203
11204 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011205 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011206 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011207 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011208 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011209 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011210 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011211
11212 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011213 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor6b906862009-08-21 00:16:32 +000011214 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011215 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011216 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011217 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011218
11219 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011220 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011221 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011222 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011223 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011224 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011225 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011226 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011227 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011228 }
11229
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011230 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011231
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011232 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11233 // non-member call based on that function.
11234 if (Method->isStatic()) {
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011235 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11236 RParenLoc);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011237 }
11238
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011239 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011240 }
11241
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011242 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
11243 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11244 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11245
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011246 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011247 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011248 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011249 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011250
Anders Carlssoneed3e692009-10-10 00:06:20 +000011251 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011252 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011253 TheCall, Method))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011254 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011255
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011256 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011257 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11258 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011259 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11260 ExprResult ObjectArg =
11261 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11262 FoundDecl, Method);
11263 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11264 return ExprError();
11265 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
11266 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011267
11268 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011269 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11270 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011271 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011272 RParenLoc))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011273 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011274
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011275 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011276
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011277 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011278 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson6f680272009-08-16 03:42:12 +000011279
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011280 if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
11281 isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
11282 TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
11283 const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
11284
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011285 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011286 Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
11287 diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
11288 << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
11289 << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
11290
11291 Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
Chandler Carruthae198062011-06-27 08:31:58 +000011292 }
Anders Carlsson2174d4c2011-05-06 14:25:31 +000011293 }
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011294 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +000011295}
11296
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011297/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
11298/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
11299/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
11300/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallf312b1e2010-08-26 23:41:50 +000011301ExprResult
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011302Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregor5c37de72008-12-06 00:22:45 +000011303 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011304 MultiExprArg Args,
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011305 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011306 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
11307 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011308 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011309
11310 UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011311 if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011312 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011313
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011314 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
11315 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011316
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011317 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
11318 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman33a31382009-08-05 19:21:58 +000011319 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011320 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
11321 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
11322 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
11323 // (E).operator().
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011324 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor44b43212008-12-11 16:49:14 +000011325 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011326
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011327 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011328 diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011329 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011330
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011331 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11332 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
11333 R.suppressDiagnostics();
11334
Douglas Gregor593564b2009-11-15 07:48:03 +000011335 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011336 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011337 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011338 Object.get()->Classify(Context),
11339 Args, CandidateSet,
John McCall314be4e2009-11-17 07:50:12 +000011340 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor3734c212009-11-07 17:23:56 +000011341 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011342
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011343 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011344 // In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
11345 // declared in T of the form
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011346 //
11347 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
11348 //
11349 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
11350 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregora967a6f2008-11-20 13:33:37 +000011351 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
11352 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
11353 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
11354 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011355 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
11356 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
11357 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
11358 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
11359 // within T by another intervening declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011360 std::pair<CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator,
11361 CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator> Conversions
Douglas Gregor90073282010-01-11 19:36:35 +000011362 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9d295432012-11-28 03:56:09 +000011363 for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
11364 I = Conversions.first, E = Conversions.second; I != E; ++I) {
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011365 NamedDecl *D = *I;
11366 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
11367 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
11368 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011369
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011370 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
11371 // surrogates.
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011372 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor4a27d702009-10-21 06:18:39 +000011373 continue;
Douglas Gregor65ec1fd2009-08-21 23:19:43 +000011374
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011375 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011376 if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
11377 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
11378 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
11379 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11380 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11381 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011382
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011383 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11384 {
11385 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011386 Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorbf6e3172011-07-23 18:59:35 +000011387 }
11388 }
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011389 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011390
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011391 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11392
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011393 // Perform overload resolution.
11394 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011395 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011396 Best)) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011397 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011398 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
11399 // below.
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011400 break;
11401
11402 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011403 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011404 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011405 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
11406 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011407 else
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011408 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall1eb3e102010-01-07 02:04:15 +000011409 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011410 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011411 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011412 break;
11413
11414 case OR_Ambiguous:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011415 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011416 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011417 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011418 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011419 break;
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011420
11421 case OR_Deleted:
Daniel Dunbar96a00142012-03-09 18:35:03 +000011422 Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011423 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
11424 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011425 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011426 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011427 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011428 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011429 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011430 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011431
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +000011432 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011433 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011434
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011435 UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11436
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011437 if (Best->Function == 0) {
11438 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
11439 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011440 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011441 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
11442 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
11443
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011444 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
Richard Smith82f145d2013-05-04 06:44:46 +000011445 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
11446 return ExprError();
Faisal Valid570a922013-06-15 11:54:37 +000011447 assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11448 "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011449 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
11450 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
11451 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011452
Fariborz Jahaniand8307b12009-09-28 18:35:46 +000011453 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanianb7400232009-09-28 23:23:40 +000011454 // and then call it.
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011455 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
11456 Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
Douglas Gregorf2ae5262011-01-20 00:18:04 +000011457 if (Call.isInvalid())
11458 return ExprError();
Abramo Bagnara960809e2011-11-16 22:46:05 +000011459 // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
11460 Call = Owned(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
11461 CK_UserDefinedConversion,
11462 Call.get(), 0, VK_RValue));
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011463
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011464 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011465 }
11466
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011467 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall41d89032010-01-28 01:54:34 +000011468
Douglas Gregor106c6eb2008-11-19 22:57:39 +000011469 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
11470 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
11471 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
11472 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011473
11474 // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
Nico Weber1a52a4d2012-11-09 08:38:04 +000011475 if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
Nico Webere0ff6902012-11-09 06:06:14 +000011476 return ExprError();
11477
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011478 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11479 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011480
11481 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011482
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011483 DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
11484 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
11485 OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011486 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011487 HadMultipleCandidates,
11488 OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11489 OpLocInfo.getInfo());
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011490 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
11491 return true;
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011492
Benjamin Kramer7034fae2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011493 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
11494 // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
11495 llvm::OwningArrayPtr<Expr *> MethodArgs(new Expr*[Args.size() + 1]);
11496 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
11497 std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]);
11498
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011499 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
11500 // owned.
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011501 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11502 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11503 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11504
Benjamin Kramer7034fae2013-09-25 13:10:11 +000011505 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
11506 CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
11507 llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1),
11508 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
11509 MethodArgs.reset();
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011510
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011511 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson07d68f12009-10-13 21:49:31 +000011512 Method))
11513 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011514
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011515 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
11516 // slots in the call for them.
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011517 if (Args.size() < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +000011518 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011519
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011520 bool IsError = false;
11521
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011522 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011523 ExprResult ObjRes =
11524 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
11525 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11526 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
11527 IsError = true;
11528 else
Benjamin Kramer3fe198b2012-08-23 21:35:17 +000011529 Object = ObjRes;
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011530 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011531
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011532 // Check the argument types.
Benjamin Kramer83372f82013-10-05 10:03:01 +000011533 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsInProto; i++) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011534 Expr *Arg;
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011535 if (i < Args.size()) {
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011536 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011537
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011538 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011539
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011540 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011541 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +000011542 Context,
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011543 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011544 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011545
Anders Carlsson3faa4862010-01-29 18:43:53 +000011546 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
11547 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011548 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011549 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011550 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
11551 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
11552 IsError = true;
11553 break;
11554 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011555
Douglas Gregord47c47d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +000011556 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor518fda12009-01-13 05:10:00 +000011557 }
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011558
11559 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
11560 }
11561
11562 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
11563 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
11564 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011565 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011566 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
11567 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
11568 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011569 }
11570 }
11571
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +000011572 if (IsError) return true;
11573
Dmitri Gribenko7297a2e2013-05-09 23:32:58 +000011574 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
Eli Friedmane61eb042012-02-18 04:48:30 +000011575
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011576 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +000011577 return true;
11578
John McCall182f7092010-08-24 06:09:16 +000011579 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregorf9eb9052008-11-19 21:05:33 +000011580}
11581
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011582/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011583/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011584/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000011585ExprResult
Kaelyn Uhrainbaaeb852013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011586Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11587 bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011588 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11589 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +000011590
John McCall5acb0c92011-10-17 18:40:02 +000011591 if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
11592 return ExprError();
John McCall0e800c92010-12-04 08:14:53 +000011593
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011594 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
11595
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011596 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
11597 //
11598 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
11599 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
11600 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
11601 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth6df868e2010-12-12 08:17:55 +000011602 DeclarationName OpName =
11603 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011604 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +000011605 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011606
John McCall5769d612010-02-08 23:07:23 +000011607 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Douglas Gregord10099e2012-05-04 16:32:21 +000011608 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
Eli Friedmanf43fb722009-11-18 01:28:03 +000011609 return ExprError();
11610
John McCalla24dc2e2009-11-17 02:14:36 +000011611 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
11612 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
11613 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlssone30572a2009-09-10 23:18:36 +000011614
11615 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011616 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor2c9a03f2011-01-26 19:30:28 +000011617 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
Dmitri Gribenko55431692013-05-05 00:41:58 +000011618 None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall701c89e2009-12-03 04:06:58 +000011619 }
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011620
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011621 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11622
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011623 // Perform overload resolution.
11624 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall120d63c2010-08-24 20:38:10 +000011625 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011626 case OR_Success:
11627 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
11628 break;
11629
11630 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Kaelyn Uhrain45c3ba72013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011631 if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
11632 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
Kaelyn Uhrainbaaeb852013-07-31 17:38:24 +000011633 if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
11634 // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
11635 // diagnostic, as requested.
11636 *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
11637 return ExprError();
11638 }
Kaelyn Uhraind4224342013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011639 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
11640 << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
Kaelyn Uhrain45c3ba72013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011641 if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
Kaelyn Uhraind4224342013-07-15 19:54:54 +000011642 Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
Kaelyn Uhrain45c3ba72013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011643 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
Kaelyn Uhrain45c3ba72013-07-11 22:38:30 +000011644 }
11645 } else
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011646 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011647 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011648 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011649 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011650
11651 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregorae2cf762010-11-13 20:06:38 +000011652 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11653 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011654 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011655 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000011656
11657 case OR_Deleted:
11658 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11659 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011660 << "->"
Douglas Gregor0a0d2b12011-03-23 00:50:03 +000011661 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahanian5e24f2a2011-02-25 20:51:14 +000011662 << Base->getSourceRange();
Ahmed Charles13a140c2012-02-25 11:00:22 +000011663 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011664 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011665 }
11666
John McCall9aa472c2010-03-19 07:35:19 +000011667 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
11668
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011669 // Convert the object parameter.
11670 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011671 ExprResult BaseResult =
11672 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
11673 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11674 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +000011675 return ExprError();
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011676 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregorfc195ef2008-11-21 03:04:22 +000011677
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011678 // Build the operator call.
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011679 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis46e75472012-02-08 01:21:13 +000011680 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011681 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11682 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011683
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011684 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
11685 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11686 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +000011687 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley429bb272011-04-08 18:41:53 +000011688 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
Lang Hamesbe9af122012-10-02 04:45:10 +000011689 Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011690
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011691 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson15ea3782009-10-13 22:43:21 +000011692 Method))
11693 return ExprError();
Eli Friedmand5931902011-04-04 01:18:25 +000011694
11695 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor8ba10742008-11-20 16:27:02 +000011696}
11697
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011698/// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
11699/// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
11700ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
11701 DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
11702 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
11703 SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
11704 TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
11705 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011706
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011707 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc);
11708 AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, true,
11709 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011710
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011711 bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11712
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011713 // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
11714 // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
11715 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11716 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
11717 case OR_Success:
11718 case OR_Deleted:
11719 break;
11720
11721 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11722 Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11723 << R.getLookupName();
11724 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11725 return ExprError();
11726
11727 case OR_Ambiguous:
11728 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
11729 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11730 return ExprError();
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011731 }
11732
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011733 FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
Nick Lewyckyf5a6aef2013-02-07 05:08:22 +000011734 ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
11735 HadMultipleCandidates,
Richard Smith36f5cfe2012-03-09 08:00:36 +000011736 SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
11737 SuffixInfo.getInfo());
11738 if (Fn.isInvalid())
11739 return true;
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011740
11741 // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
11742 // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011743 Expr *ConvArgs[2];
Richard Smith958ba642013-05-05 15:51:06 +000011744 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011745 ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
11746 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
11747 SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
11748 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11749 return true;
11750 ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.take();
11751 }
11752
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011753 QualType ResultTy = FD->getResultType();
11754 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11755 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11756
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011757 UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
Benjamin Kramer3b6bef92012-08-24 11:54:20 +000011758 new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.take(),
11759 llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011760 ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
11761
11762 if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getResultType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
11763 return ExprError();
11764
Richard Smith831421f2012-06-25 20:30:08 +000011765 if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, NULL))
Richard Smith9fcce652012-03-07 08:35:16 +000011766 return ExprError();
11767
11768 return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
11769}
11770
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011771/// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
11772/// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
11773/// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
11774/// dependent lookup.
11775/// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
11776/// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
11777/// is returned.
11778Sema::ForRangeStatus
11779Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
11780 SourceLocation RangeLoc, VarDecl *Decl,
11781 BeginEndFunction BEF,
11782 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
11783 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
11784 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
11785 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
11786 CandidateSet->clear();
11787 if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
11788 ExprResult MemberRef =
11789 BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
11790 /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
11791 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
11792 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/0,
11793 MemberLookup,
11794 /*TemplateArgs=*/0);
11795 if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
11796 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11797 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11798 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11799 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11800 }
Dmitri Gribenko62ed8892013-05-05 20:40:26 +000011801 *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, 0);
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011802 if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
11803 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11804 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11805 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11806 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11807 }
11808 } else {
11809 UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011810 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
11811 UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/0,
11812 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
11813 /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
Richard Smithb1502bc2012-10-18 17:56:02 +000011814 FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011815
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011816 bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011817 CandidateSet, CallExpr);
11818 if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
11819 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11820 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11821 }
11822 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11823 OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11824 CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11825
11826 if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
11827 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11828 return FRS_NoViableFunction;
11829 }
Dmitri Gribenko9e00f122013-05-09 21:02:07 +000011830 *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
Sam Panzere1715b62012-08-21 00:52:01 +000011831 Loc, 0, CandidateSet, &Best,
11832 OverloadResult,
11833 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
11834 if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
11835 *CallExpr = ExprError();
11836 Diag(Range->getLocStart(), diag::note_in_for_range)
11837 << RangeLoc << BEF << Range->getType();
11838 return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
11839 }
11840 }
11841 return FRS_Success;
11842}
11843
11844
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011845/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
11846/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
11847/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
11848/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlsson96ad5332009-10-21 17:16:23 +000011849/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +000011850Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011851 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011852 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011853 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
11854 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011855 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011856 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011857
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011858 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011859 }
11860
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011861 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011862 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
11863 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011864 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011865 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor097bfb12009-10-23 22:18:25 +000011866 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011867 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011868 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011869 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011870
11871 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +000011872 ICE->getCastKind(),
11873 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +000011874 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011875 }
11876
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011877 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011878 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000011879 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011880 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
11881 if (Method->isStatic()) {
11882 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
11883 // from non-member functions.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011884 } else {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011885 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
11886 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
11887 // or template.
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011888 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11889 Found, Fn);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011890 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011891 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011892
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011893 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
11894 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
11895 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
11896 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
11897
11898 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
11899 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
11900 // appropriate pointer to member type.
11901 QualType ClassType
11902 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
11903 QualType MemPtrType
11904 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
11905
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011906 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
11907 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11908 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregorb86b0572009-02-11 01:18:59 +000011909 }
11910 }
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000011911 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
11912 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011913 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011914 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011915
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +000011916 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011917 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011918 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000011919 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000011920 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011921
11922 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011923 // FIXME: avoid copy.
11924 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011925 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011926 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11927 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +000011928 }
11929
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011930 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11931 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011932 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011933 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011934 /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011935 ULE->getNameLoc(),
11936 Fn->getType(),
11937 VK_LValue,
11938 Found.getDecl(),
11939 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011940 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011941 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
11942 return DRE;
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +000011943 }
11944
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +000011945 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011946 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011947 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
11948 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11949 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11950 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11951 }
John McCalld5532b62009-11-23 01:53:49 +000011952
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011953 Expr *Base;
11954
John McCallf89e55a2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000011955 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
11956 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011957 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
11958 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011959 DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
11960 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011961 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011962 Fn,
John McCallf4b88a42012-03-10 09:33:50 +000011963 /*enclosing*/ false,
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011964 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11965 Fn->getType(),
11966 VK_LValue,
11967 Found.getDecl(),
11968 TemplateArgs);
Richard Smithe6975e92012-04-17 00:58:00 +000011969 MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011970 DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
11971 return DRE;
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011972 } else {
11973 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
11974 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor4c9be892011-02-28 20:01:57 +000011975 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Eli Friedman72899c32012-01-07 04:59:52 +000011976 CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +000011977 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
11978 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
11979 /*isImplicit=*/true);
11980 }
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011981 } else
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000011982 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +000011983
John McCallf5307512011-04-27 00:36:17 +000011984 ExprValueKind valueKind;
11985 QualType type;
11986 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
11987 valueKind = VK_LValue;
11988 type = Fn->getType();
11989 } else {
11990 valueKind = VK_RValue;
11991 type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
11992 }
11993
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011994 MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
11995 MemExpr->isArrow(),
11996 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
Abramo Bagnarae4b92762012-01-27 09:46:47 +000011997 MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000011998 Fn,
11999 Found,
12000 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
12001 TemplateArgs,
12002 type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
12003 ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
Richard Smith4a030222012-11-14 07:06:31 +000012004 MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
Abramo Bagnara7cc58b42011-10-05 07:56:41 +000012005 return ME;
Douglas Gregor699ee522009-11-20 19:42:02 +000012006 }
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012007
John McCall3fa5cae2010-10-26 07:05:15 +000012008 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +000012009}
12010
NAKAMURA Takumidfbb02a2011-01-27 07:10:08 +000012011ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +000012012 DeclAccessPair Found,
12013 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +000012014 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor20093b42009-12-09 23:02:17 +000012015}
12016
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000012017} // end namespace clang